Lexmark All in One Printer 279 User Manual

XM1135  
User's Guide  
March 2014  
Machine type(s):  
7015  
Model(s):  
279  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Safety information  
6
Safety information  
Connect the power cord directly to an appropriately rated and properly grounded electrical outlet that is near the  
product and easily accessible.  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Do not use this product with extension cords, multioutlet power strips,  
multioutlet extenders, or other types of surge or UPS devices. The power rating capacity of these types of  
accessories can be easily overloaded by a laser printer and may result in poor printer performance, property  
damage, or potential fire.  
Do not place or use this product near water or wet locations.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: Do not use the fax feature during a lightning storm. Do not set up this product or  
make any electrical or cabling connections, such as the fax feature, power cord, or telephone, during a lightning  
storm.  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately. Keep all  
other trays closed until needed.  
Refer service or repairs, other than those described in the user documentation, to a service representative.  
This product is designed, tested, and approved to meet strict global safety standards with the use of specific  
manufacturer's components. The safety features of some parts may not always be obvious. The manufacturer is not  
responsible for the use of other replacement parts.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: Make sure that all external connections (such as Ethernet and telephone system  
connections) are properly installed in their marked plug-in ports.  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: This product uses a laser. Use of controls or adjustments or performance of  
procedures other than those specified herein may result in hazardous radiation exposure.  
This product uses a printing process that heats the print media, and the heat may cause the media to release emissions.  
You must understand the section in your operating instructions that discusses the guidelines for selecting print media  
to avoid the possibility of harmful emissions.  
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a hot  
component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The lithium battery in this product is not intended to be replaced. There is a  
danger of explosion if a lithium battery is incorrectly replaced. Do not recharge, disassemble, or incinerate a  
lithium battery. Discard used lithium batteries according to the manufacturer's instructions and local  
regulations.  
Use only the telecommunications (RJ11) cord provided with this product or a 26 AWG or larger replacement when  
connecting this product to the public switched telephone network.  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Do not cut, twist, bind, crush, or place heavy objects on the power cord. Do not  
subject the power cord to abrasion or stress. Do not pinch the power cord between objects such as furniture  
and walls. If any of these things happen, a risk of fire or electrical shock results. Inspect the power cord regularly  
for signs of such problems. Remove the power cord from the electrical outlet before inspecting it.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock when cleaning the exterior of the printer,  
unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet and disconnect all cables from the printer before proceeding.  
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Floor-mounted configurations require additional furniture for stability. You must  
use either a printer stand or printer base if you are using multiple input options. If you purchased a  
multifunction printer (MFP) that scans, copies, and faxes, then you may need additional furniture. For more  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Safety information  
7
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware or  
memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord  
from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn  
them off as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The printer weight is greater than 18 kg (40 lb) and requires two or more  
trained personnel to lift it safely.  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Before moving the printer, follow these guidelines to avoid personal injury or  
printer damage:  
Turn the printer off using the power switch, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
Disconnect all cords and cables from the printer before moving it.  
If an optional tray is installed, then remove it from the printer. To remove the optional tray, slide the latch on the  
right side of the tray toward the front of the tray until it clicks into place.  
Use the handholds located on both sides of the printer to lift it.  
Make sure your fingers are not under the printer when you set it down.  
Before setting up the printer, make sure there is adequate clearance around it.  
Use only the power cord provided with this product or the manufacturer's authorized replacement.  
SAVE THESE INSTRUCTIONS.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Learning about the printer  
8
Learning about the printer  
Finding information about the printer  
What are you looking for?  
Find it here  
Initial setup instructions:  
Setup documentation—The setup documentation came  
with the printer and is also available at  
Connecting the printer  
Installing the printer software  
Additional setup and instructions for using the printer:  
Selecting and storing paper and specialty media  
Loading paper  
User's Guide and Quick Reference Guide—The guides are  
available on the Documentation CD.  
For more information, visit  
Configuring printer settings  
Viewing and printing documents and photos  
Setting up and using the printer software  
Configuring the printer on a network  
Caring for and maintaining the printer  
Troubleshooting and solving problems  
Instructions for:  
Networking Guide—Open the Software CD, and then  
navigate to:  
Connecting the printer to an Ethernet network  
Troubleshooting printer connection problems  
Documentation > User’s Guide and other publications >  
Networking Guide  
Help using the printer software  
WindowsorMac Help—Openaprintersoftware program  
or application, and then click Help.  
?
Click  
to view contextsensitive information.  
Notes:  
Help is automatically installed with the printer  
software.  
The printer software is located in the printer  
program folder or on the desktop, depending on  
your operating system.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Learning about the printer  
9
What are you looking for?  
Find it here  
The latest supplemental information, updates, and customer  
support:  
Lexmark Support Web site—  
Documentation  
Driver downloads  
Live chat support  
Email support  
Voice support  
Note: Select your country or region, and then select  
your product to view the appropriate support site.  
Support telephone numbers and hours of operation for  
your country or region can be found on the Support Web  
site or on the printed warranty that came with your  
printer.  
Record the following information (located on the store  
receipt and at the back of the printer), and have it ready  
when you contact customer support so that they may  
serve you faster:  
Machine Type number  
Serial number  
Date purchased  
Store where purchased  
Warranty information  
Warranty information varies by country or region:  
In the U.S.—See the Statement of Limited Warranty  
included with this printer, or at  
In other countries and regions—See the printed  
warranty that came with your printer.  
Selecting a location for the printer  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The printer weight is greater than 18 kg (40 lb) and requires two or more  
trained personnel to lift it safely.  
When selecting a location for the printer, leave enough room to open trays, covers, and doors. If you plan to install any  
options, then leave enough room for them also. It is important to:  
Set up the printer near a properly grounded and easily accessible electrical outlet.  
Make sure airflow in the room meets the latest revision of the ASHRAE 62 standard or the CEN Technical Committee  
156 standard.  
Provide a flat, sturdy, and stable surface.  
Keep the printer:  
Clean, dry, and free of dust.  
Away from stray staples and paper clips.  
Away from the direct airflow of air conditioners, heaters, or ventilators.  
Free from direct sunlight and humidity extremes.  
Observe the recommended temperatures and avoid fluctuations:  
Ambient temperature 15.6 to 32.2°C (60 to 90°F)  
Storage temperature 40 to 60°C (-40 to 140°F)  
Allow the following recommended amount of space around the printer for proper ventilation:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Learning about the printer  
10  
5
4
1
1
3
2
1
2
3
4
5
Right side 300 mm (12 in.)  
Front 510 mm (20 in.)  
Left side 200 mm (8 in.)  
Rear  
Top  
200 mm (8 in.)  
540 mm (21 in.)  
Printer configurations  
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Floor-mounted configurations require additional furniture for stability. You must  
use either a printer stand or printer base if you are using multiple input options. If you purchased a  
multifunction printer (MFP) that scans, copies, and faxes, then you may need additional furniture. For more  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately. Keep all  
other trays closed until needed.  
You can configure your printer by adding one optional 250or 550sheet tray. For instructions on installing the optional  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Learning about the printer  
11  
2
3
1
4
10  
9
5
8
7
6
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Printer control panel  
Automatic document feeder (ADF)  
ADF tray  
ADF bin  
Front door release button  
Standard 250sheet tray  
Optional 250or 550sheet tray  
50sheet multipurpose feeder  
Paper stop  
10 Standard bin  
Understanding the basic functions of the scanner  
Make quick copies or set the printer to perform specific copy jobs.  
Send a fax using the printer control panel.  
Send a fax to multiple fax destinations at the same time.  
Scan documents and send them to your computer, an e-mail address, or an FTP destination.  
Scan documents and send them to another printer (PDF through an FTP).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Learning about the printer  
12  
Using the ADF and scanner glass  
Automatic document feeder (ADF)  
Scanner glass  
Use the ADF for multiplepage documents.  
Note: The ADF scans only one side of the page.  
Use the scanner glass for singlepage documents, book pages, small items  
(such as postcards or photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media  
(such as magazine clippings).  
Using the ADF  
Load the document into the ADF tray faceup, short edge first.  
Load up to 50 sheets of plain paper into the ADF tray.  
Scan sizes from 105 x 148 mm (4.1 x 5.8 inches) wide to 216 x 368 mm (8.5 x 14.5 inches) long.  
Scan media weights from 52 to 120 g/m2 (14–32 lb).  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine clippings)  
into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
Using the scanner glass  
When using the scanner glass:  
Place the document facedown on the scanner glass in the corner with the green arrow.  
Scan or copy documents up to 216 x 296.9 mm (8.5 x 11.69 inches).  
Copy books up to 12.7 mm (0.5 inch) thick.  
Using the printer control panel  
5
2
3
1
7
4
6
13  
8
9
10  
12  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Learning about the printer  
13  
Use the  
To  
View the printer status and messages.  
1
Display  
Set up and operate the printer.  
2
3
Arrow buttons  
Select button  
Scroll up and down or left and right.  
Select menu options.  
Save settings.  
4
5
6
7
Address book button View all the stored addresses.  
Redial button  
Keypad  
View the last number dialed.  
Enter numbers, letters, or symbols.  
Sleep button  
Enable Sleep mode or Hibernate mode.  
Do the following to wake the printer from Sleep mode:  
Press any hard button.  
Open a door or cover.  
Send a print job from the computer.  
Perform a poweron reset using the main power switch.  
8
9
Cancel button  
Start button  
Cancel all printer activity.  
Start a job, depending on which mode is selected.  
Send faxes.  
10 Fax button  
11 Back button  
12 Home button  
13 Indicator light  
Return to the previous screen.  
Go to the home screen.  
Check the status of the printer.  
Understanding the colors of the Sleep button and indicator  
lights  
Thecolorsofthe Sleepbuttonandindicatorlightsonthe printercontrolpanelsignifya certainprinterstatusorcondition.  
Indicator light  
Off  
Printer status  
The printer is off or in Hibernate mode.  
The printer is warming up, processing data, or printing.  
The printer is on, but idle.  
Blinking green  
Solid green  
Blinking red  
The printer requires user intervention.  
Sleep button light  
Off  
Printer status  
The printer is off, idle or in Ready state.  
The printer is in Sleep mode.  
Solid amber  
Blinking amber  
The printer is entering or waking from Hibernate mode.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Learning about the printer  
14  
Sleep button light  
Printer status  
Blinking amber for 0.1 second, then goes  
completely off for 1.9 seconds in a slow,  
pulsing pattern  
The printer is in Hibernate mode.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
15  
Additional printer setup  
Installing internal options  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware or  
memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord  
from the electircal outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn  
them off as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity.  
Touch a metal surface on the printer before touching any controller board electronic components or connectors.  
Available internal options  
Memory cards  
Flash memory  
Fonts  
Accessing the controller board  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware or  
memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord  
from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn  
them off as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
1 Open the controller board access door.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Additional printer setup  
16  
2 Open the controller board shield using the green handle.  
1
2
3 Use the following illustration to locate the option card connector.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity.  
Touch something metal on the printer before touching any controller board electronic components or  
connectors.  
4 Close the shield, and then the access door.  
1
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
17  
Installing an optional card  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware or  
memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord  
from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have other devices attached to the printer, then turn them  
off as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Controller board electronic components are easily damaged by static electricity.  
Touch something metal on the printer before touching any controler board electronic components or connectors.  
1 Access the controller board.  
2 Unpack the optional card.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Avoid touching the connection points along the edge of the card.  
3 Holding the card by its sides, align the plastic pins (1) on the card with the holes (2) on the controller board.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
18  
4 Push the card firmly into place as shown in the illustration.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Improper installation of the card may cause damage to the card and the  
controller board.  
Note: The entire length of the connector on the card must touch and be flushed against the controller board.  
5 Close the controller board shield, and then the controller board access door.  
Note: When the printer software and any hardware options are installed, it may be necessary to manually add  
the options in the printer driver to make them available for print jobs. For more information, see “Adding  
Installing hardware options  
Order of installation  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The printer weight is greater than 18 kg (40 lb) and requires two or more  
trained personnel to lift it safely.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Additional printer setup  
19  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware or  
memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord  
from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn  
them off as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Floor-mounted configurations require additional furniture for stability. You must  
use either a printer stand or printer base if you are using multiple input options. If you purchased a  
multifunction printer (MFP) that scans, copies, and faxes, then you may need additional furniture. For more  
Install the printer and any hardware options you have purchased in the following order:  
Printer stand  
Optional 250or 550sheet tray  
Printer  
For more information on installing a printer stand, optional 250or 550sheet tray, or spacer, see the setup sheet that  
came with the option.  
Installing optional trays  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The printer weight is greater than 18 kg (40 lb) and requires two or more  
trained personnel to lift it safely.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: If you are accessing the controller board or installing optional hardware or  
memory devices sometime after setting up the printer, then turn the printer off, and unplug the power cord  
from the electrical outlet before continuing. If you have any other devices attached to the printer, then turn  
them off as well, and unplug any cables going into the printer.  
CAUTION—TIPPING HAZARD: Floor-mounted configurations require additional furniture for stability. You must  
use either a printer stand or printer base if you are using multiple input options. If you purchased a  
multifunction printer (MFP) that scans, copies, and faxes, then you may need additional furniture. For more  
1 Turn off the printer using the power switch, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
1
2
2 Unpack the tray, and then remove all packing material.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
20  
3 Pull out the tray from the base.  
4 Remove any packing material from inside the tray.  
5 Insert the tray into the base.  
6 Place the tray near the printer.  
7 Align the printer with the tray, and then slowly lower the printer into place.  
Note: Optional trays lock together when stacked.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
21  
8 Connect the power cord to the printer, then to a properly grounded electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.  
2
1
Notes:  
When the printer software and any hardware options are installed, you may need to manually add the  
options in the printer driver to make them available for print jobs. For more information, see “Adding  
To uninstall the optional trays, slide the latch on the right side of the printer toward the front of the printer  
until it clicks into place, and then remove stacked trays one at a time from the top to the bottom.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Additional printer setup  
22  
Attaching cables  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: Do not use the fax feature during a lightning storm. Do not set up this product or  
make any electrical or cabling connections, such as the fax feature, power cord, or telephone, during a lightning  
storm.  
Connect the printer to the computer using a USB cable or to the network using an Ethernet cable.  
Make sure to match the following:  
The USB symbol on the cable with the USB symbol on the printer  
The appropriate Ethernet cable with the Ethernet port  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the USB cable, any network adapter, or the printer in the area shown  
while actively printing or scanning. Loss of data or a malfunction can occur.  
Use the  
To  
1
Printer power cord Connect the printer to a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
socket  
2
3
4
Power switch  
Ethernet port  
EXT port  
Turn the printer on or off.  
Connect the printer to an Ethernet network.  
Connect additional devices (telephone or answering machine) to the printer and the  
telephone line. Use this port if you do not have a dedicated fax line for the printer and if this  
connection method is supported in your country or region.  
Note: Remove the adapter plug to access the port.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
23  
Use the  
To  
5
LINE port  
Connect the printer to an active telephone line through a standard wall jack (RJ11), DSL filter,  
or VoIP adapter, or any other adapter that allows you to access the telephone line to send  
and receive faxes.  
6
7
USB printer port  
Security slot  
Connect the printer to a computer.  
Attach a lock that will secure the printer in place.  
Setting up the printer software  
Installing the printer  
1 Obtain a copy of the software installer package.  
2 Run the installer, and then follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
3 For Macintosh users, add the printer.  
Note: Obtain the printer IP address from the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu.  
Adding available options in the print driver  
For Windows users  
1 Open the printers folder.  
In Windows 8  
From the Search charm, type run, and then navigate to:  
Run > type control printers> OK  
In Windows 7 or earlier  
a Click  
, or click Start and then click Run.  
b Type control printers.  
c Press Enter, or click OK.  
2 Select the printer you want to update, and then do either of the following:  
For Windows 7 or later, select Printer properties.  
For earlier versions, select Properties.  
3 Navigate to the Configuration tab, and then select Update Now Ask Printer.  
4 Apply the changes.  
For Macintosh users  
1 From System Preferences in the Apple menu, navigate to your printer, and then select Options & Supplies.  
2 Navigate to the list of hardware options, and then add any installed options.  
3 Apply the changes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Additional printer setup  
24  
Networking  
Notes:  
Purchase a MarkNetTM N8352 wireless network adapter first before setting up the printer on a wireless network.  
For information on installing the wireless network adapter, see the setup sheet that came with the adapter.  
A Service Set Identifier (SSID) is a name assigned to a wireless network. Wired Equivalent Privacy (WEP), Wi-Fi  
Protected Access (WPA), and WPA2 are types of security used on a network.  
Preparing to set up the printer on an Ethernet network  
To configure your printer to connect to an Ethernet network, organize the following information before you begin:  
Note: If your network automatically assigns IP addresses to computers and printers, continue on to installing the  
printer.  
A valid, unique IP address for the printer to use on the network  
The network gateway  
The network mask  
A nickname for the printer (optional)  
Note: A printer nickname can make it easier for you to identify your printer on the network. You can choose to  
use the default printer nickname, or assign a name that is easier for you to remember.  
You will need an Ethernet cable to connect the printer to the network and an available port where the printer can  
physically connect to the network. Use a new network cable when possible to avoid potential problems caused by a  
damaged cable.  
Preparing to set up the printer on a wireless network  
Notes:  
Make sure your wireless network adapter is installed in your printer and working properly. For more  
information, see the instruction sheet that came with the wireless network adapter.  
Make sure your access point (wireless router) is turned on and is working properly.  
Make sure you have the following information before setting up the printer on a wireless network:  
SSID—The SSID is also referred to as the network name.  
Wireless Mode (or Network Mode)—The mode is either infrastructure or ad hoc.  
Channel (for ad hoc networks)—The channel defaults to automatic for infrastructure networks.  
Some ad hoc networks will also require the automatic setting. Check with your system support person if you are  
not sure which channel to select.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Additional printer setup  
25  
Security Method—There are four basic options for Security Method:  
WEP key  
If your network uses more than one WEP key, then enter up to four in the provided spaces. Select the key  
currently in use on the network by selecting the default WEP transmit key.  
WPA or WPA2 preshared key or passphrase  
WPA includes encryption as an additional layer of security. The choices are AES or TKIP. Encryption must be set  
for the same type on the router and on the printer, or the printer will not be able to communicate on the  
network.  
802.1X–RADIUS  
If you are installing the printer on an 802.1X network, then you may need the following:  
Authentication type  
Inner authentication type  
802.1X user name and password  
Certificates  
No security  
If your wireless network does not use any type of security, then you will not have any security information.  
Note: We do not recommend using an unsecured wireless network.  
Notes:  
If you do not know the SSID of the network that your computer is connected to, then launch the wireless utility  
of the computer network adapter, and then look for the network name. If you cannot find the SSID or the  
security information for your network, then see the documentation that came with the access point, or contact  
your system support person.  
To find the WPA/WPA2 preshared key or passphrase for the wireless network, see the documentation that  
came with the access point, see the Embedded Web Server associated with the access point, or consult your  
system support person.  
Connecting the printer using the Wireless Setup Wizard  
Before you begin, make sure that:  
A wireless network adapter is installed in the printer and is working properly. For more information, see the  
instruction sheet that came with the wireless network adapter.  
An Ethernet cable is disconnected from the printer.  
Active NIC is set to Auto. To set this to Auto, navigate to:  
> Settings >  
> Network/Ports >  
> Active NIC >  
> Auto >  
Note: Make sure to turn off the printer, then wait for at least five seconds, and then turn the printer back on.  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings >  
> Network/Ports >  
> Network [x] >  
> Network [x] Setup >  
> Wireless >  
>
Wireless Connection Setup >  
2 Select a wireless connection setup.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
26  
Use  
To  
Search for networks  
Show available wireless connections.  
Note: This menu item shows all broadcast secured or unsecured SSIDs.  
Enter a network name Manually type the SSID.  
Note: Make sure to type the correct SSID.  
WiFi Protected Setup Connect the printer to a wireless network using WiFi Protected Setup.  
3 Press  
, and then follow the instructions on the printer display.  
Connecting the printer to a wireless network using Wi-Fi Protected Setup  
Before you begin, make sure that:  
The access point (wireless router) is WiFi Protected Setup (WPS) certified or WPScompatible. For more  
information, see the documentation that came with your access point.  
A wireless network adapter is installed in the printer and is working properly. For more information, see the  
instruction sheet that came with the wireless network adapter.  
Using the Push Button Configuration (PBC) method  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings >  
>Network/Ports >  
> Network [x] >  
> Network [x] Setup >  
> Wireless >  
>
>
Wireless Connection Setup >  
> WiFi Protected Setup >  
> Start Push Button Method >  
2 Follow the instructions on the printer display.  
Using the Personal Identification Number (PIN) method  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings >  
>Network/Ports >  
> Network [x] >  
> Network [x] Setup >  
> Wireless >  
Wireless Connection Setup >  
> WiFi Protected Setup >  
> Start PIN Method >  
2 Copy the eightdigit WPS PIN.  
3 Open a Web browser, and then type the IP address of your access point in the address bar.  
Notes:  
The IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
4 Access the WPS settings. For more information, see the documentation that came with your access point.  
5 Enter the eightdigit PIN, and then save the setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Additional printer setup  
27  
Connecting the printer to a wireless network using the Embedded Web Server  
Before you begin, make sure that:  
Your printer is connected temporarily to an Ethernet network.  
A wireless network adapter is installed in your printer and working properly. For more information, see the  
instruction sheet that came with the wireless network adapter.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer control panel. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers  
separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Network/Ports > Wireless.  
3 Modify the settings to match the settings of your access point (wireless router).  
Note: Make sure to enter the correct SSID, security method, preshared key or passphrase, network mode, and  
channel.  
4 Click Submit.  
5 Turn off the printer, and then disconnect the Ethernet cable. Then wait for at least five seconds, and then turn the  
printer back on.  
6 To verify if your printer is connected to the network, print a network setup page. Then in the Network Card [x]  
section, see if the status is Connected.  
Verifying printer setup  
Printing a menu settings page  
Print a menu settings page to view the current menu settings and to verify if the printer options are installed correctly.  
From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings > Reports >  
> Menu Settings Page >  
Note: If you have not changed any menu settings, then the menu settings page lists all the factory default settings.  
Settings saved from the menus replace the factory default settings as user default settings. A user default setting  
remains in effect until you access the menu again, select another value, and save it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Additional printer setup  
28  
Printing a network setup page  
If the printer is attached to a network, then print a network setup page to verify the network connection. This page  
also provides important information that aids network printing configuration.  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings >  
> Reports >  
> Network Setup Page >  
2 Check the first section of the network setup page, and then confirm that the status is Connected.  
If the status is Not Connected, then the LAN drop may not be active, or the network cable may be malfunctioning.  
Consult your system support person for a solution, and then print another network setup page.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Loading paper and specialty media  
29  
Loading paper and specialty media  
The selection and handling of paper and specialty media can affect how reliably documents print. For more information,  
Setting the paper size and type  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings >  
> Paper Menu >  
> Paper Size/Type >  
2 Press the up or down arrow button to select the tray or feeder, and then press  
3 Press the up or down arrow button to select the paper size, and then press  
4 Press the up or down arrow button to select the paper type, and then press  
.
.
to change the settings.  
Configuring Universal paper settings  
The Universal paper size is a userdefined setting that lets you print on paper sizes that are not preset in the printer  
menus.  
Notes:  
The smallest supported Universal paper size is 76.2 x 76.2 mm (3 x 3 inches), and is supported only from the  
multipurpose feeder.  
The largest supported Universal paper size is 215.9 x 359.92 mm (8.5 x 14.17 inches), and is supported from all  
paper sources.  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings >  
measure >  
> Paper Menu >  
> Universal Setup >  
> Units of Measure >  
> select a unit of  
2 Select Portrait Width or Portrait Height, and then press  
.
3 Press the left or right arrow button to change the setting, and then press  
.
Loading trays  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: To reduce the risk of equipment instability, load each tray separately. Keep all  
other trays closed until needed.  
1 Pull out the tray completely.  
Note: Do not remove trays while a job prints or while Busyappears on the printer display. Doing so may cause  
a jam.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Loading paper and specialty media  
30  
2 Squeeze and then slide the width guide tab to the correct position for the size of the paper you are loading.  
1
A
4
LT  
R
EX  
EC  
5  
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
31  
3 Squeeze and then slide the length guide tab to the correct position for the size of the paper you are loading.  
1
A
4
LT  
R
E
X
E
C
B
5
2
Notes:  
For some paper sizes like letter, legal, and A4, squeeze and slide the length guide tab backward to  
accommodate their length.  
When loading legalsize paper, the length guide extends beyond the base leaving the paper exposed to dust.  
To protect the paper from dust, you can purchase a dust cover separately. For more information, contact  
customer support.  
If you are loading A6-size paper in the standard tray, then squeeze and then slide the length guide tab  
toward the center of the tray to the A6size position.  
Make sure the width and length guides are aligned with the paper size indicators on the bottom of the tray.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
32  
A
4
LT  
R
E
X
E
C
B5  
A
5
4 Flex the sheets back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper. Straighten the  
edges on a level surface.  
5 Load the paper stack.  
Notes:  
Load with the printable side facedown when using recycled or preprinted paper.  
Load prepunched paper with the holes on the top edge toward the front of the tray.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
33  
Load letterhead facedown, with the top edge of the sheet toward the front of the tray. For twosided  
printing, load letterhead faceup with the bottom edge of the sheet toward the front of the tray.  
Make sure the paper is below the maximum paper fill indicator located on the side of the width guide.  
6 Insert the tray.  
7 From the printer control panel, set the paper size and paper type in the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in  
the tray.  
Note: Set the correct paper size and type to avoid paper jams and print quality problems.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
34  
Loading the multipurpose feeder  
Use the multipurpose feeder when printing on different paper sizes and types or specialty media, such as card stock,  
transparencies, paper labels, and envelopes. You can also use it for singlepage print jobs on letterhead.  
1 Open the multipurpose feeder.  
a Pull the multipurpose feeder extender.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Loading paper and specialty media  
35  
b Pull the extender gently so that the multipurpose feeder is fully extended and open.  
2 Squeeze the tab on the left width guide, and then move the guides for the paper you are loading.  
1
2
3 Prepare the paper or specialty media for loading.  
Flexsheetsof paper back andforthtoloosenthem, andthenfanthem. Donotfoldorcrease the paper. Straighten  
the edges on a level surface.  
Hold transparencies by the edges. Flex the stack of transparencies back and forth to loosen them, and then fan  
them. Straighten the edges on a level surface.  
Note: Avoid touching the printable side of the transparencies. Be careful not to scratch them.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
36  
Flex the stack of envelopes back and forth to loosen them, and then fan them. Straighten the edges on a level  
surface.  
4 Load the paper or specialty media.  
Notes:  
Do not force paper or specialty media into the multipurpose feeder.  
Make sure the paper or specialty media is below the maximum paper fill indicator located on the paper  
guides. Overfilling may cause paper jams.  
Load paper, transparencies, and card stock with the recommended printable side faceup and the top edge  
entering the printer first. For more information on loading transparencies, see the packaging that the  
transparencies came in.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
37  
Note: When loading A6size paper, make sure the multipurpose feeder extender rests lightly against the  
edge of the paper so that the last few sheets of paper remain in place.  
Load letterhead faceup with the top edge entering the printer first. For twosided (duplex) printing, load  
letterhead facedown with the bottom edge entering the printer first.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading paper and specialty media  
38  
Load envelopes with the flap on the left side facedown.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Never use envelopes with stamps, clasps, snaps, windows, coated linings, or  
selfstick adhesives. These envelopes may severely damage the printer.  
5 From the printer control panel, set the paper size and paper type in the Paper menu to match the paper or specialty  
media loaded in the multipurpose feeder.  
Linking and unlinking trays  
The printer links trays when the specified paper size and type are the same. When a linked tray becomes empty, paper  
feeds from the next linked tray. To prevent trays from linking, assign a unique custom paper type name.  
Linking and unlinking trays  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address on the printer control panel in the TCP/IP section under the Network/Ports  
menu. The IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Paper Menu.  
3 Change the paper size and type settings for the trays you are linking.  
To link trays, make sure the paper size and type for the tray match that of the other tray.  
To unlink trays, make sure the paper size or type for the tray does not match that of the other tray.  
4 Click Submit.  
Note: You can also change the paper size and type settings using the printer control panel. For more information,  
Warning—Potential Damage: Paper loaded in the tray should match the paper type name assigned in the printer.  
The temperature of the fuser varies according to the specified paper type. Printing issues may occur if settings are  
not properly configured.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Loading paper and specialty media  
39  
Creating a custom name for a paper type  
Using the Embedded Web Server  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Paper Menu > Custom Names.  
3 Select a custom name, and then type a new custom paper type name.  
4 Click Submit.  
5 Click Custom Types, and then verify if the new custom paper type name has replaced the custom name.  
Using the printer control panel  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings >  
> Paper Menu >  
> Custom Names  
2 Select a custom name, and then type a new custom paper type name.  
3 Press  
.
4 Press Custom Types, and then verify if the new custom paper type name has replaced the custom name.  
Assigning a custom paper type  
Using the Embedded Web Server  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Paper Menu > Custom Types.  
3 Select a custom paper type name, and then select a paper type.  
Note: Paper is the factory default paper type for all userdefined custom names.  
4 Click Submit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Loading paper and specialty media  
40  
Using the printer control panel  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings >  
> Paper Menu >  
> Custom Types  
2 Select a custom paper type name, and then select a paper type.  
Note: Paper is the factory default paper type for all userdefined custom names.  
3 Press  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Paper and specialty media guide  
41  
Paper and specialty media guide  
Notes:  
Make sure the paper size, type, and weight are set correctly on the computer or control panel.  
Flex, fan, and straighten specialty media before loading them.  
The printer may print at a reduced speed to prevent damage to the fuser.  
For more information on card stock and labels, see the Card Stock & Label Guide on the Lexmark support Web  
Paper guidelines  
Selecting the correct paper or specialty media reduces printing problems. For the best print quality, try a sample of the  
paper or specialty media before buying large quantities.  
Paper characteristics  
The following paper characteristics affect print quality and reliability. Consider these characteristics when evaluating  
new paper stock.  
Weight  
The printer trays can automatically feed paper weights up to 120g/m2 (32lb) bond grain long paper. The multipurpose  
feeder can automatically feed paper weights up to 163g/m2 (43lb) bond grain long paper. Paper lighter than  
60 g/m2 (16 lb) might not be stiff enough to feed properly, causing jams. For best performance, use 75g/m2 (20lb)  
bond grain long paper. For paper smaller than 182 x 257 mm (7.2 x 10.1 inches), we recommended to use 90 g/m2  
(24 lb) or heavier paper.  
Note: Twosided printing is supported only for 60–90g/m2 (16–24lb) bond paper.  
Curl  
Curl is the tendency for paper to curl at its edges. Excessive curl can cause paper feeding problems. Curl can occur after  
the paper passes through the printer, where it is exposed to high temperatures. Storing paper unwrapped in hot, humid,  
cold, or dry conditions, even in the trays, can contribute to paper curling prior to printing and can cause feeding  
problems.  
Smoothness  
Paper smoothness directly affects print quality. If paper is too rough, then toner cannot fuse to it properly. If paper is  
too smooth, then it can cause paper feeding or print quality issues. Always use paper between 100 and 300 Sheffield  
points; however, smoothness between 150 and 250 Sheffield points produces the best print quality.  
Moisture content  
The amount of moisture in paper affects both print quality and the ability of the printer to feed the paper correctly.  
Leave paper in its original wrapper until it is time to use it. This limits the exposure of paper to moisture changes that  
can degrade its performance.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Paper and specialty media guide  
42  
Store paper in its original wrapper in the same environment as the printer for 24 to 48 hours before printing. Extend  
the time to several days if the storage or transportation environment is very different from the printer environment.  
Thick paper may also require a longer conditioning period.  
Grain direction  
Grain refers to the alignment of the paper fibers in a sheet of paper. Grain is either grain long, running the length of  
the paper, or grain short, running the width of the paper.  
For 60–90g/m2 (16–24lb) bond paper, grain long paper is recommended.  
Fiber content  
Most highquality xerographic paper is made from 100% chemically treated pulped wood. This content provides the  
paper with a high degree of stability resulting in fewer paper feeding problems and better print quality. Paper containing  
fibers such as cotton can negatively affect paper handling.  
Selecting paper  
Using the appropriate paper prevents jams and helps ensure troublefree printing.  
To help avoid paper jams and poor print quality:  
Always use new, undamaged paper.  
Before loading paper, know the recommended printable side of the paper. This information is usually indicated on  
the paper package.  
Do not use paper that has been cut or trimmed by hand.  
Do not mix paper sizes, types, or weights in the same tray; mixing results in jams.  
Do not use coated papers unless they are specifically designed for electrophotographic printing.  
Selecting preprinted forms and letterhead  
Use these guidelines when selecting preprinted forms and letterhead:  
Use grain long for 60 to 90 g/m2 (16 to 24 lb) weight paper.  
Use only forms and letterhead printed using an offset lithographic or engraved printing process.  
Avoid papers with rough or heavily textured surfaces.  
Use papers printed with heatresistant inks designed for use in xerographic copiers. The ink must be able to withstand  
temperatures up to 230°C (446°F) without melting or releasing hazardous emissions. Use inks that are not affected by  
the resin in toner. Inks that are oxidationset or oilbased generally meet these requirements; latex inks might not.  
When in doubt, contact the paper supplier.  
Preprinted papers such as letterhead must be able to withstand temperatures up to 230°C (446°F) without melting or  
releasing hazardous emissions.  
Using recycled paper and other office papers  
As an environmentally conscientious company, Lexmark supports the use of recycled paper produced specifically for  
use in laser (electrophotographic) printers.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Paper and specialty media guide  
43  
While no blanket statement can be made that all recycled paper will feed well, Lexmark consistently tests papers that  
represent recycled cut size copier papers available on the global market. This scientific testing is conducted with rigor  
and discipline. Many factors are taken into consideration both separately and as a whole, including the following:  
Amount of post-consumer waste (Lexmark tests up to 100% post-consumer waste content.)  
Temperature and humidity conditions (Testing chambers simulate climates from all over the world.)  
Moisture content (Business papers should have low moisture: 4–5%.)  
Bending resistance and proper stiffness means optimum feeding through the printer.  
Thickness (impacts how much can be loaded into a tray)  
Surface roughness (measured in Sheffield units, impacts print clarity and how well toner fuses to the paper)  
Surface friction (determines how easily sheets can be separated)  
Grain and formation (impacts curling, which also influences the mechanics of how the paper behaves as it moves  
through the printer)  
Brightness and texture (look and feel)  
Recycled papers are better than ever; however, the amount of recycled content in a paper affects the degree of control  
over foreign matter. And while recycled papers are one goodpath to printing in an environmentally responsible manner,  
they are not perfect. The energy required to de-ink and deal with additives such as colorants and “glue” often generates  
more carbon emissions than does normal paper production. However, using recycled papers enables better resource  
management overall.  
Lexmark concerns itself with the responsible use of paper in general based on life cycle assessments of its products. To  
gain a better understanding of the impact of printers on the environment, the company commissioned a number of  
life cycle assessments and found that paper was identified as the primary contributor (up to 80%) of carbon emissions  
caused throughout the entire life of a device (from design to end-of-life). This is due to the energy-intensive  
manufacturing processes required to make paper.  
Thus, Lexmark seeks to educate customers and partners on minimizing the impact of paper. Using recycled paper is  
one way. Eliminating excessive and unnecessary paper consumption is another. Lexmark is well-equipped to help  
customers minimize printing and copying waste. In addition, the company encourages purchasing paper from suppliers  
who demonstrate their commitment to sustainable forestry practices.  
Lexmark does not endorse specific suppliers, although a converter’s product list for special applications is maintained.  
However, the following paper choice guidelines will help alleviate the environmental impact of printing:  
1 Minimize paper consumption.  
2 Be selective about the origin of wood fiber. Buy from suppliers who carry certifications such as the Forestry  
Stewardship Council (FSC) or the Program for the Endorsement of Forest Certification (PEFC). These certifications  
guarantee that the paper manufacturer uses wood pulp from forestry operators that employ environmentally and  
socially responsible forest management and restoration practices.  
3 Choose the most appropriate paper for printing needs: normal 75 or 80 g/m2 certified paper, lower weight paper,  
or recycled paper.  
Unacceptable paper examples  
Test results indicate that the following paper types are at risk for use with laser printers:  
Chemically treated papers used to make copies without carbon paper, also known as carbonless papers  
Preprinted papers with chemicals that may contaminate the printer  
Preprinted papers that can be affected by the temperature in the printer fuser  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Paper and specialty media guide  
44  
Preprinted papers that require a registration (the precise location on the page) greater than ± 2.3 mm (± 0.9 in.),  
such as optical character recognition (OCR) forms. In some cases, registration can be adjusted with a software  
application to successfully print on these forms.)  
Coated papers (erasable bond), synthetic papers, thermal papers  
Rough-edged, rough or heavily textured surface papers or curled papers  
Recycled papers that fail EN12281:2002 (European testing)  
Paper weighing less than 60 g/m2 (16 lb)  
Multiple part forms or documents  
For more information about Lexmark, visit www.lexmark.com. General sustainability-related information can be found  
at the Environmental Sustainability link.  
Supported paper sizes, types, and weights  
Supported paper sizes  
Paper size and dimension Standard  
250sheet tray  
Optional 250or Multipurpose  
ADF  
Scanner  
glass  
Duplex  
printing  
550sheet tray  
feeder  
Business card  
3 x 5 in.  
4 x 6 in.  
A4  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
1
1
210 x 297 mm  
(8.27 x 11.7 in.)  
A5  
X
X
X
148 x 210 mm  
(5.83 x 8.27 in.)  
A6  
X
105 x 148 mm  
(4.13 x 5.83 in.)  
JIS B5  
182 x 257 mm  
(7.17 x 10.1 in.)  
Letter  
215.9 x 279.4 mm  
(8.5 x 11 in.)  
1 Paper is supported only if the paper size setting is set to Universal.  
2 Paper is supported in twosided (duplex) printing only if the width is at least 210 mm (8.27 in.) and the length is at least  
279.4 mm (11 in.). The smallest supported Universal paper size is supported only in the multipurpose feeder.  
3 Paper is supported only if the width is at least 215.9 mm (8.5 in.) and the length is at least 296.9 mm (11.7 in.).  
4 Paper is supported only if the length is at least 296.9 mm (11.7 in.).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Paper and specialty media guide  
45  
Paper size and dimension Standard  
Optional 250or Multipurpose  
ADF  
Scanner  
glass  
Duplex  
printing  
250sheet tray  
550sheet tray  
feeder  
Legal  
X
215.9 x 355.6 mm  
(8.5 x 14 in.)  
Executive  
X
184.2 x 266.7 mm  
(7.25 x 10.5 in.)  
Oficio (México)  
X
X
215.9 x 340.4 mm  
(8.5 x 13.4 in.)  
Folio  
215.9 x 330.2 mm  
(8.5 x 13 in.)  
Statement  
X
139.7 x 215.9 mm  
(5.5 x 8.5 in.)  
Universal2  
3
76.2 x 127 mm (3 x 5 in.) to  
215.9 x 359.92 mm  
(8.5 x 14.17 in.)  
7 3/4 Envelope (Monarch)  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
98.4 x 190.5 mm  
(3.875 x 7.5 in.)  
9 Envelope  
X
X
X
X
98.4 x 226.1 mm  
(3.875 x 8.9 in.)  
10 Envelope  
104.8 x 241.3 mm  
(4.12 x 9.5 in.)  
DL Envelope  
110 x 220 mm  
(4.33 x 8.66 in.)  
C5 Envelope  
162 x 229 mm  
(6.38 x 9.01 in.)  
1 Paper is supported only if the paper size setting is set to Universal.  
2 Paper is supported in twosided (duplex) printing only if the width is at least 210 mm (8.27 in.) and the length is at least  
279.4 mm (11 in.). The smallest supported Universal paper size is supported only in the multipurpose feeder.  
3 Paper is supported only if the width is at least 215.9 mm (8.5 in.) and the length is at least 296.9 mm (11.7 in.).  
4 Paper is supported only if the length is at least 296.9 mm (11.7 in.).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Paper and specialty media guide  
46  
Paper size and dimension Standard  
Optional 250or Multipurpose  
ADF  
Scanner  
glass  
Duplex  
printing  
250sheet tray  
550sheet tray  
feeder  
B5 Envelope  
X
X
X
X
176 x 250 mm  
(6.93 x 9.84 in.)  
Other Envelope  
X
X
X
X
4
85.7 x 165 mm to  
215.9 x 355.6 mm  
(3.375 x 6.50 in. to  
8.5 x 14 in.)  
1 Paper is supported only if the paper size setting is set to Universal.  
2 Paper is supported in twosided (duplex) printing only if the width is at least 210 mm (8.27 in.) and the length is at least  
279.4 mm (11 in.). The smallest supported Universal paper size is supported only in the multipurpose feeder.  
3 Paper is supported only if the width is at least 215.9 mm (8.5 in.) and the length is at least 296.9 mm (11.7 in.).  
4 Paper is supported only if the length is at least 296.9 mm (11.7 in.).  
Supported paper types and weights  
The standard tray supports 60–90g/m2 (16–24lb) paper weights. The optional tray supports 60–120g/m2 (16–32lb)  
paper weights. The multipurpose feeder supports 60–163g/m2 (16–43lb) paper weights.  
Paper type  
250or  
Multipurpose feeder  
Duplex mode  
ADF  
Scanner glass  
550sheet tray  
Plain paper  
Card stock  
Transparencies  
Recycled  
X
X
X
Paper labels1  
Bond  
X
Envelope2  
X
X
X
X
X
X
Rough envelope  
Letterhead  
Preprinted  
Colored paper  
Light paper  
1 Onesided paper labels designed for laser printers are supported for occasional use. We recommend printing only up to  
20 pages of paper labels per month. Vinyl, pharmacy, and twosided labels are not supported.  
2 Use envelopes that lie flat when individually placed on a table facedown.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Paper and specialty media guide  
47  
Paper type  
250or  
Multipurpose feeder  
Duplex mode  
ADF  
Scanner glass  
550sheet tray  
Heavy paper  
Rough/Cotton  
Custom Type [x]  
X
1 Onesided paper labels designed for laser printers are supported for occasional use. We recommend printing only up to  
20 pages of paper labels per month. Vinyl, pharmacy, and twosided labels are not supported.  
2 Use envelopes that lie flat when individually placed on a table facedown.  
Using specialty media  
Tips on using letterhead  
Use letterhead designed specifically for laser printers.  
Print samples on the letterhead being considered for use before buying large quantities.  
Before loading letterhead, flex, fan, and straighten the stack to prevent sheets from sticking together.  
Page orientation is important when printing on letterhead. For information on how to load letterhead, see:  
Tips on using transparencies  
Print a test page on the transparencies being considered for use before buying large quantities.  
Feed transparencies from the standard tray, or the multipurpose feeder.  
Use transparencies designed specifically for laser printers. Transparencies must be able to withstand temperatures  
up to 185°C (365°F) without melting, discoloring, offsetting, or releasing hazardous emissions.  
Note: If the transparency weight is set to Heavy and the transparency texture is set to Rough in the Paper menu,  
then transparencies can be printed at a temperature up to 195°C (383°F).  
Avoid getting fingerprints on the transparencies to prevent print quality problems.  
Before loading transparencies, flex, fan, and straighten the stack to prevent sheets from sticking together.  
Tips on using envelopes  
Print samples on the envelopes being considered for use before buying large quantities.  
Use envelopes designed specifically for laser printers. Check with the manufacturer or vendor to ensure that the  
envelopes can withstand temperatures up to 230°C (446°F) without sealing, wrinkling, curling excessively, or  
releasing hazardous emissions.  
For best performance, use envelopes made from 90g/m2 (24lb bond) paper or 25% cotton. Allcotton envelopes  
must not exceed 75g/m2 (20lb bond) weight.  
Use only new envelopes from undamaged packages.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Paper and specialty media guide  
48  
To optimize performance and minimize jams, do not use envelopes that:  
Have excessive curl or twist  
Are stuck together or damaged in any way  
Have windows, holes, perforations, cutouts, or embossing  
Have metal clasps, string ties, or folding bars  
Have an interlocking design  
Have postage stamps attached  
Have any exposed adhesive when the flap is in the sealed or closed position  
Have bent corners  
Have rough, cockle, or laid finishes  
Adjust the width guides to fit the width of the envelopes.  
Note: A combination of high humidity (over 60%) and high printing temperature may wrinkle or seal envelopes.  
Tips on using labels  
Print samples on the labels being considered for use before buying large quantities.  
Note: Use only paper label sheets. Vinyl, pharmacy, and twosided labels are not supported.  
For more information on label printing, characteristics, and design, see the Card Stock & Label Guide available at  
When printing on labels:  
Use labels designed specifically for laser printers. Check with the manufacturer or vendor to verify that:  
The labels can withstand temperatures up to 240°C (464°F) without sealing, excessive curling, wrinkling, or  
releasing hazardous emissions.  
Label adhesives, facesheet(printable stock), andtopcoatscanwithstandupto172kPa(25psi)pressure without  
delaminating, oozing around the edges, or releasing hazardous fumes.  
Do not use labels with slick backing material.  
Use full label sheets. Partial sheets may cause labels to peel off during printing, resulting in a jam. Partial sheets  
also contaminate the printer and the cartridge with adhesive, and could void the printer and toner cartridge  
warranties.  
Do not use labels with exposed adhesive.  
Do not print within 1 mm (0.04 inch) of the edge of the label, of the perforations, or between diecuts of the label.  
Make sure the adhesive backing does not reach to the edge of the sheet. Zone coating of the adhesive should be  
at least 1 mm (0.04 inch) away from edges. Adhesive material contaminates the printer and could void the warranty.  
If zone coating of the adhesive is not possible, then remove a 2mm (0.08inch) strip on the leading and driver edge,  
and then use a nonoozing adhesive.  
Portrait orientation is recommended, especially when printing bar codes.  
Tips on using card stock  
Card stock is heavy, singleply specialty media. Many of its variable characteristics, such as moisture content, thickness,  
and texture, can significantly impact print quality. Print samples on the card stock being considered for use before  
buying large quantities.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Paper and specialty media guide  
49  
When printing on card stock:  
Make sure the Paper Type is Card Stock.  
Select the appropriate Paper Texture setting.  
Be aware that preprinting, perforation, and creasing may significantly affect the print quality and cause jams or  
other paper handling problems.  
Check with the manufacturer or vendor to ensure that the card stock can withstand temperatures up to 240°C  
(464°F) without releasing hazardous emissions.  
Do not use preprinted card stock manufactured with chemicals that may contaminate the printer. Preprinting  
introduces semiliquid and volatile components into the printer.  
Use grain short card stock when possible.  
Storing paper  
Use these paper storage guidelines to help avoid jams and uneven print quality:  
For best results, store paper where the temperature is 21°C (70°F) and the relative humidity is 40 percent. Most  
label manufacturers recommend printing in a temperature range of 18–24°C (65–75°F) with relative humidity  
between 40 and 60 percent.  
Store paper in cartons, on a pallet or shelf, rather than on the floor.  
Store individual packages on a flat surface.  
Do not store anything on top of individual paper packages.  
Take paper out of the carton or wrapper only when you are ready to load it in the printer. The carton and wrapper  
help keep the paper clean, dry, and flat.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Printing  
50  
Printing  
Printing a document  
Printing a document  
1 From the Paper menu on the printer control panel, set the paper type and size to match the paper loaded.  
2 Send the print job:  
For Windows users  
a With a document open, click File > Print.  
b Click Properties, Preferences, Options, or Setup.  
c Adjust the settings, if necessary.  
d Click OK > Print.  
For Macintosh users  
a Customize the settings in the Page Setup dialog if necessary:  
1 With a document open, choose File > Page Setup.  
2 Choose a paper size or create a custom size to match the paper loaded.  
3 Click OK.  
b Customize the settings in the Page Setup dialog if necessary:  
1 With a document open, choose File > Print.  
If necessary, click the disclosure triangle to see more options.  
2 From the Print dialog and popup menus adjust the settings if necessary.  
Note: To print on a specific paper type, adjust the paper type setting to match the paper loaded, or  
select the appropriate tray or feeder.  
3 Click Print.  
Adjusting toner darkness  
Using the Embedded Web Server  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the IP address of the printer in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Print Settings > Quality Menu > Toner Darkness.  
3 Adjust the toner darkness, and then click Submit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Printing  
51  
Using the printer control panel  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings >  
> Print Settings >  
> Quality Menu >  
> Toner Darkness  
2 Adjust the toner darkness, and then press  
.
Printing from a mobile device  
To download a compatible mobile printing application, visit www.lexmark.com/mobile.  
Note: Mobile printing applications may also be available from your mobile device manufacturer.  
Printing confidential and other held jobs  
Storing print jobs in the printer  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings >  
> Security >  
> Confidential Print > select the print job type  
Print job type  
Description  
Max Invalid PIN  
Limits the number of times an invalid PIN can be entered.  
Note: When the limit is reached, the print jobs for that user name and PIN are  
deleted.  
Confidential Job Expiration  
Lets you hold print jobs in the computer until you enter the PIN from the printer  
control panel.  
Note: The PIN is set from the computer. It must be four digits, using the  
numbers 0–9.  
Repeat Job Expiration  
Verify Job Expiration  
Lets you print and store print jobs in the printer memory for reprinting.  
Lets you print one copy of a print job while the printer holds the remaining  
copies. It allows you to examine if the first copy is satisfactory. The print job is  
automatically deleted from the printer memory once all copies are printed.  
Reserve Job Expiration  
Lets you store print jobs for printing at a later time. The print jobs are held until  
deleted from the Held Jobs menu.  
Notes:  
Confidential, Verify, Reserve, and Repeat print jobs may be deleted if the printer requires extra memory to  
process additional held jobs.  
You can set the printer to store print jobs in the printer memory until you start the print job from the printer  
control panel.  
All print jobs that can be initiated by the user at the printer are called held jobs.  
2 Press  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Printing  
52  
Printing confidential and other held jobs  
Note: Confidential and Verify print jobs are automatically deleted from memory after printing. Repeat and Reserve  
jobs are held in the printer until you choose to delete them.  
For Windows users  
1 With a document open, click File > Print.  
2 Click Properties, Preferences, Options, or Setup.  
3 Click Print and Hold.  
4 Select the print job type (Confidential, Repeat, Reserve, or Verify), and then assign a user name. For a confidential  
print job, also enter a fourdigit PIN.  
5 Click OK or Print.  
6 From the printer control panel, release the print job.  
For confidential print jobs, navigate to:  
Held jobs > select your user name > Confidential Jobs > enter the PIN > select the print job > specify the number  
of copies > Print  
For other print jobs, navigate to:  
Held jobs > select your user name > select the print job > specify the number of copies > Print  
For Macintosh users  
1 With a document open, choose File > Print.  
If necessary, click the disclosure triangle to see more options.  
2 From the print options or Copies & Pages popup menu, choose Job Routing.  
3 Select the print job type (Confidential, Repeat, Reserve, or Verify), and then assign a user name. For a confidential  
print job, also enter a fourdigit PIN.  
4 Click OK or Print.  
5 From the printer control panel, release the print job:  
For confidential print jobs, navigate to:  
Held jobs > select your user name > Confidential Jobs > enter the PIN > select the print job > specify the number  
of copies > Print  
For other print jobs, navigate to:  
Held jobs > select your user name > select the print job > specify the number of copies > Print  
Modifying confidential print settings  
Note: This feature is available only in network printers or printers connected to print servers.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Printing  
53  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings tab > Security > Confidential Print Setup.  
3 Modify the settings:  
Set a maximum number of PIN entry attempts. When a user exceeds a specific number of PIN entry attempts,  
all of the jobs for that user are deleted.  
Set an expiration time for confidential print jobs. When a user has not printed the jobs within the specified time,  
all of the jobs for that user are deleted.  
4 Save the modified settings.  
Printing information pages  
Printing a font sample list  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings >  
> Reports >  
> Print Fonts  
2 Press the up or down arrow button to select the font setting.  
3 Press  
.
Note: The PPDS fonts appear only when the PPDS data stream is activated.  
Canceling a print job  
Canceling a print job from the printer control panel  
1 From the printer control panel, press  
.
2 When a list of print jobs appears, select the job to cancel, and then press  
3 Press to go back to the home screen.  
.
Canceling a print job from the computer  
For Windows users  
1 Open the printers folder, and then select your printer.  
2 From the print queue, select the print job you want to cancel, and then delete it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Printing  
54  
For Macintosh users  
1 From System Preferences in the Apple menu, navigate to your printer.  
2 From the print queue, select the print job you want to cancel, and then delete it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Copying  
55  
Copying  
Automatic document feeder (ADF)  
Scanner glass  
Use the ADF for multiplepage documents.  
Note: The ADF scans only one side of the sheet.  
Use the scanner glass for single-page documents, book pages, small items  
(such as postcards or photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media  
(such as magazine clippings).  
Making copies  
Making a quick copy  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
Note: To avoid a cropped image, make sure the size of the original document and the size of the copy paper are  
the same.  
3 From the printer control panel, press  
.
Copying using the ADF  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Copying  
56  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 Adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, use the keypad to enter the number of copies, and then press  
.
.
Copying using the scanner glass  
1 Place an original document facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner.  
2 From the printer control panel, use the keypad to enter the number of copies, and then press  
Note: If you want to scan another document, then place the next document on the scanner glass, press the left  
or right arrow button to scroll to Scan the Next Page, and then press  
.
3 Press the left or right arrow button to scroll to Finish the Job, and then press  
.
Copying photos  
1 Place a photo facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner.  
2 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Copy >  
3 From the Content Source menu, choose a setting that best describes the original photo your are copying, and then  
press  
Note: If you want to copy another photo, then place it on the scanner glass, press the left or right arrow button  
to scroll to Scan the Next Page, and then press  
> Content Type > Photo  
.
.
4 Press the left or right arrow button to scroll to Finish the Job, and then press  
.
Copying on specialty media  
Copying on transparencies  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Copying  
57  
3 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Copy >  
> Copy from > select the size of the original document  
4 Navigate to:  
Copy to >  
> select the tray containing the transparencies >  
> select the number of copies or enter a  
number on the keypad >  
5 If there are no trays that contain transparencies, then do the following:  
a Navigate to:  
Copy to >  
> Manual Feeder >  
> select the size of the transparencies >  
> Transparency >  
b Load transparencies into the multipurpose feeder, and then press  
Note: If you want to copy another document, then place it on the scanner glass, press the left or right arrow  
button to scroll to Scan the Next Page, and then press  
.
.
6 Press the left or right arrow button to scroll to Finish the Job, and then press  
.
Copying on letterhead  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Copy >  
> Copy from > select the size of the original document  
4 Navigate to:  
Copy to >  
> select the tray containing the letterhead >  
> select the number of copies or enter a number  
on the keypad >  
5 If there are no trays that contain letterhead, then do the following:  
a Navigate to:  
Copy to >  
> Manual Feeder >  
> select the size of the letterhead > Letterhead  
b Place the letterhead faceup, top edge first into the multipurpose feeder, and then press  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Copying  
58  
Note: If you want to copy another document, then place it on the scanner glass, press the left or right arrow  
button to scroll to Scan the Next Page, and then press  
.
6 Press the left or right arrow button to scroll to Finish the Job, and then press  
.
Customizing copy settings  
Copying to a different size  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Copy >  
> Copy from > select the size of the original document  
4 Navigate to:  
Copy to >  
> select a new size for the copy > select the number of copies or enter a number on the keypad >  
Note: If you want to copy another document, then place it on the scanner glass, press the left or right arrow  
button to scroll to Scan the Next Page, and then press  
.
5 Press the left or right arrow button to scroll to Finish the Job, and then press  
.
Making copies using paper from a selected tray  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Copy >  
> Copy from > select the size of the original document  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Copying  
59  
4 Navigate to:  
Copy to >  
> select the tray containing the paper size and type you want to use >  
> select the number of  
copies or enter a number on the keypad >  
5 If there are no trays that contain the paper size and type you want to use, then do the following:  
a Navigate to:  
Copy to >  
> Manual Feeder >  
> select the paper size >  
> select the paper type >  
b Load the size and type of paper into the multipurpose feeder, and then press  
Note: If you want to copy another document, then place it on the scanner glass, press the left or right arrow button  
to scroll to Scan the Next Page, and then press  
.
.
6 Press the left or right arrow button to scroll to Finish the Job, and then press  
.
Reducing or enlarging copies  
Copies can be scaled from 25% to 400% of the original document size.  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Copy >  
> Scale > adjust the scale setting > select the number of copies or enter a number on the keypad >  
Note: If you want to copy another document, then place it on the scanner glass, press the left or right arrow  
button to scroll to Scan the Next Page, and then press  
.
4 Press the left or right arrow button to scroll to Finish the Job, and then press  
.
Making a copy lighter or darker  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass in the upper  
left corner.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Copying  
60  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Copy >  
> Darkness > adjust the darkness setting > select the number of copies or enter a number on  
the keypad >  
Note: If you want to copy another document, then place it on the scanner glass, press the left or right arrow  
button to scroll to Scan the Next Page, and then press  
.
4 Press the left or right arrow button to scroll to Finish the Job, and then press  
.
Adjusting copy quality  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Copy >  
> Content Type > select the content type of the original document  
4 Press the left or right arrow button to scroll to one of the following:  
Text—The content of the original document is mostly text or line art.  
Text/Photo—The original document is a mixture of text and graphics or photos.  
Photo—The original document is mostly a photo or an image.  
Graphics—The original document is mostly businesstype graphics, such as pie charts, bar charts, and  
animations.  
5 Press the up or down arrow button until Content Sourceappears, and then press the left or right arrow button  
to scroll to one of the following:  
Color Laser—The original document was printed using a color laser printer.  
Inkjet—The original document was printed using an inkjet printer.  
Magazine—The original document is from a magazine.  
Press—The original document is from an offset press.  
Black/White Laser—The original document was printed using a mono laser printer.  
Photo/Film—The original document is a photo from a film.  
Newspaper—The original document is from a newspaper.  
Other—The original document was printed using an alternate or unknown printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Copying  
61  
6 Select the number of copies or enter a number on the keypad, and then press  
.
Note: If you want to copy another document, then place it on the scanner glass, press the left or right arrow  
button to scroll to Scan the Next Page, and then press  
.
7 Press the left or right arrow button to scroll to Finish the Job, and then press  
.
Collating copies  
If you print multiple copies of a document, then you can choose to print each copy as a set (collated) or to print the  
copies as groups of pages (not collated).  
Collated  
Not collated  
To select a Collate setting:  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Copy >  
> Collate > select the collate setting you want > select the number of copies or enter a number  
on the keypad >  
Note: If you want to copy another document, then place it on the scanner glass, press the left or right arrow  
button to scroll to Scan the Next Page, and then press  
.
4 Press the left or right arrow button to scroll to Finish the Job, and then press  
.
Placing separator sheets between copies  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Copying  
62  
3 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Copy >  
> Separator Sheets  
4 Select Between Copies, Between Jobs, Between Pages, or Off.  
5 Select the number of copies or enter a number on the keypad, and then press  
.
Note: If you want to copy another document, then place it on the scanner glass, press the left or right arrow  
button to scroll to Scan the Next Page, and then press  
.
6 Press the left or right arrow button to scroll to Finish the Job, and then press  
.
Copying multiple pages onto a single sheet  
To save paper, you can copy either two or four consecutive pages of a multiplepage document onto a single sheet of  
paper.  
Notes:  
Make sure the paper size is set to letter, legal, A4, or JIS B5.  
The copy size must be set to 100%.  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Copy >  
> Paper Saver > select the setting that you want  
4 Select Off, 2up Portrait, 2up Landscape, 4up Portrait, or 4up Landscape.  
5 Select the number of copies or enter a number on the keypad, and then press  
.
Note: If you want to copy another document, then place it on the scanner glass, press the left or right arrow  
button to scroll to Scan the Next Page, and then press  
.
6 Press the left or right arrow button to scroll to Finish the Job, and then press  
.
Placing information on copies  
Placing an overlay message on each page  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Copying  
63  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Copy >  
> Overlay > select an overlay message you want  
4 Select Off, Confidential, Copy, Draft, Urgent, or Custom.  
5 Select the number of copies or enter a number on the keypad, and then press  
.
Note: If you want to copy another document, then place it on the scanner glass, press the left or right arrow  
button to scroll to Scan the Next Page, and then press  
.
6 Press the left or right arrow button to scroll to Finish the Job, and then press  
.
Canceling a copy job  
Canceling a copy job from the printer control panel  
1 From the printer control panel, press  
.
2 When a list of copy jobs appears, select the job to cancel, and then press  
3 Press to go back to the home screen.  
.
Understanding the copy options  
Copies  
This option lets you set the number of copies to be printed.  
Copy from  
This option opens a screen where you can select the paper size of the original document.  
To scroll to the paper size that matches the original document, press the left or right arrow button, and then press  
.
To copy an original document that contains mixed paper sizes with the same width, press the left or right arrow  
button to scroll to Mixed Sizes, and then press  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Copying  
64  
To set the printer to automatically detect the size of the original document, press the left or right arrow button to  
scroll to Auto Size Sense, and then press  
.
Copy to  
This option lets you select the paper size and type on which your copies will be printed.  
To scroll to the paper size and type that matches the paper loaded in the tray or feeder, press the left or right arrow  
button, and then press  
.
If the settings for “Copy from” and “Copy to” are different, then the printer automatically adjusts the Scale setting  
to accommodate the difference.  
If the paper type or size you want to use is not loaded in one of the trays, then press the left or right arrow button  
to scroll to Manual Feeder, press  
, and then manually load the paper in the manual feeder or multipurpose  
feeder.  
To match each copy to the paper size of the original document, set “Copy to” to Auto Size Match. If a matching  
paper size is not in one of the trays, then Paper size not foundappears and prompts to load a paper in a  
tray, manual feeder, or multipurpose feeder.  
Scale  
This option lets you scale the document from 25% to 400% of the original document size. You can also set automatic  
scaling.  
When copying to a different paper size, such as from legalsize to lettersize paper, set the “Copy from” and “Copy  
to” paper sizes automatically to scale the scan image to fit the size of the paper onto which you are copying.  
To decrease or increase the value by 1%, press the left or right arrow button on the printer control panel. To make  
a continuous decrease or increase in value, press and hold the button for two or more seconds.  
Darkness  
This option lets you adjust how light or dark the copies are in relation to the original document.  
Sides (Duplex)  
This option lets you make one- or two-sided copies from one- or two-sided original documents.  
Collate  
This option keeps the pages of a print job stacked in sequence when printing multiple copies of the document.  
Content Type  
This option lets you set the original document type.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Copying  
65  
Select from the following content types:  
Graphics—The original document is mostly businesstype graphics, such as pie charts, bar charts, and animations.  
Photo—The original document is mostly a photo or an image.  
Text—The content of the original document is mostly text or line art.  
Text/Photo—The original document is a mixture of text, graphics, and photos.  
Content Source  
This option lets you set the original document source.  
Select from the following content sources:  
Color Laser—The original document was printed using a color laser printer.  
Black/White Laser—The original document was printed using a mono laser printer.  
Inkjet—The original document was printed using an inkjet printer.  
Photo/Film—The original document is a photo from a film.  
Magazine—The original document is from a magazine.  
Newspaper—The original document is from a newspaper.  
Press—The original document was printed using a printing press.  
Other—The original document was printed using an alternate or unknown printer.  
Advanced Duplex  
This option lets you specify the document orientation, whether documents are one-sided or two-sided, and how  
documents are bound.  
Overlay  
This option lets you create a watermark (or message) that overlays the content of your copy. You can choose from  
Confidential, Copy, Draft, Urgent, and Custom. You can type a custom message in the ”Enter the Custom Text Overlay  
and press OK” field. The message will appear, faintly, in large print across each page.  
Separator Sheets  
This option lets you place a blank sheet of paper between copies, prints, pages, print jobs or copy jobs. The separator  
sheets can be drawn from a tray that contains a type or color of paper that is different from the paper your copies are  
printed on.  
Paper Saver  
This option lets you print two or more pages of an original document on the same page. Paper Saver is also called N-  
up printing where N stands for the number of pages. For example, 2-up would print two pages of your document on a  
single page, and 4-up would print four pages of your document on a single page.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
E-mailing  
66  
E-mailing  
Automatic document feeder (ADF)  
Scanner glass  
Use the ADF for multiplepage documents.  
Note: The ADF scans only one side of the sheet.  
Use the scanner glass for single-page documents, book pages, small items  
(such as postcards or photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media  
(such as magazine clippings).  
Setting up the printer to e-mail  
Setting up the e-mail function  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > E-mail/FTP Settings > E-mail Settings.  
3 Enter the appropriate information, and then click Submit.  
Configuring email settings  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > E-mail/FTP Settings > E-mail Settings.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
E-mailing  
67  
3 Enter the appropriate information, and then click Submit.  
Creating an e-mail shortcut  
Creating an e-mail shortcut using the Embedded Web Server  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Manage Shortcuts > E-mail Shortcut Setup.  
3 Type a name for the shortcut, and then enter the e-mail address.  
Note: If you are entering multiple addresses, then separate each address with a comma (,).  
4 Adjust the scan settings, if necessary.  
5 Enter a shortcut number, and then click Add.  
If you enter a number that is already in use, then you are prompted to select another number.  
E-mailing a document  
Sending an email using a shortcut number  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 Press #, then enter the shortcut number using the keypad, and then press  
4 Press  
.
.
Canceling an e-mail  
From the printer control panel, press  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Faxing  
68  
Faxing  
Automatic document feeder (ADF)  
Scanner glass  
Use the ADF for multiplepage documents.  
Note: The ADF scans only one side of the sheet.  
Use the scanner glass for single-page documents, book pages, small items  
(such as postcards or photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media  
(such as magazine clippings).  
Setting up the printer to fax  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: Do not use the fax feature during a lightning storm. Do not set up this product or  
make any electrical or cabling connections, such as the fax feature, power cord, or telephone, during a lightning  
storm.  
Notes:  
The following connection methods are applicable only in select countries or regions.  
During the initial printer setup, clear the fax function check box and any other function you plan to set up later,  
and then select Continue.  
The indicator light may blink red if the fax function is enabled and not fully set up.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the cables or the printer in the area shown while actively sending or  
receiving a fax.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Faxing  
69  
Initial fax setup  
Many countries and regions require outgoing faxes to contain the following information in a margin at the top or bottom  
of each transmitted page, or on the first page of the transmission: fax name (identification of the business, other entity,  
or individual sending the message) and fax number (telephone number of the sending fax machine, business, other  
entity, or individual).  
To enter your fax setup information, use the printer control panel, or use your browser to access the Embedded Web  
Server, and then open the Settings menu.  
Note: If you do not have a TCP/IP environment, then you must use the printer control panel to enter your fax setup  
information.  
Using the printer control panel for fax setup  
When the printer is turned on for the first time, a series of startup screens appear. If the printer has fax capabilities,  
then the Fax Name or Station Name and Fax Number or Station Number screens appear:  
1 When Fax Nameor Station Nameappears, type the name to be printed on all outgoing faxes, and then press  
.
2 When Fax Numberor Station Numberappears, enter the printer fax number, and then press  
.
Using the Embedded Web Server for fax setup  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Fax Settings > Analog Fax Setup.  
3 In the Fax Settings menu, type the name to be printed on all outgoing faxes in the Fax Name or Station Name field.  
4 In the Fax Number or Station Number field, enter the printer fax number.  
5 Click Submit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Faxing  
70  
Choosing a fax connection  
Scenario 1: Standard telephone line  
Setup 1: Printer is connected to a dedicated fax line  
To connect:  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with the printer to the port of the printer.  
2 Connect the other end of the telephone cable to an active analog wall jack.  
Tips for this setup:  
You can set the printer to receive faxes automatically (Auto Answer On) or manually (Auto Answer Off).  
If you want to receive faxes automatically (Auto Answer On), then set the printer to pick up on any number of rings  
that you want.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Faxing  
71  
Setup 2: Printer is sharing the line with an answering machine  
Connected to the same telephone wall jack  
PHONE  
LINE  
To connect:  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with the printer to the port of the printer.  
2 Connect the other end of the telephone cable to an active analog wall jack.  
3 Connect the answering machine to the  
port of the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Faxing  
72  
Connected to different wall jacks  
PHONE  
LINE  
To connect:  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with the printer to the port of the printer.  
2 Connect the other end of the telephone cable to an active analog wall jack.  
Tips for this setup:  
If you have only one telephone number on your line, then you need to set the printer to receive faxes automatically  
(Auto Answer On).  
Set the printer to pick up calls two rings after the answering machine. For example, if the answering machine picks  
up calls after four rings, then set the printer to pick up after six rings. This way, the answering machine picks up  
calls first and your voice calls are received. If the call is a fax, then the printer detects the fax signal on the line and  
takes over the call.  
If you subscribe to a distinctive ring service provided by your telephone company, then make sure that you set the  
correct ring pattern for the printer. Otherwise, the printer does not receive faxes even if you have set it to receive  
faxes automatically.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Faxing  
73  
Setup 3: Printer is sharing the line with a telephone subscribed to voice mail service  
0 2  
To connect:  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with the printer to the port of the printer.  
2 Connect the other end of the telephone cable to an active analog wall jack.  
3 Connect the telephone to the  
port of the printer.  
Tips for this setup:  
This setup works best if you subscribe to a distinctive ring service. If you have distinctive ring service, then make  
sure that you set the correct ring pattern for the printer. Otherwise, the printer does not receive faxes even if you  
have set it to receive faxes automatically.  
If you have only one telephone number on your line, then you need to set the printer to receive faxes manually  
(Auto Answer Off).  
When you answer the telephone and you hear fax tones, press *9* or the manual answer code on the telephone  
to receive the fax.  
You can also set the printer to receive faxes automatically (Auto Answer On), but you need to turn off the voice  
mail service when you are expecting a fax. This setting works best if you are using voice mail more often than fax.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Faxing  
74  
Scenario 2: Digital Subscriber Line (DSL)  
A Digital Subscriber Line splits your regular telephone line into two channels: voice and Internet. Telephone and fax  
signals travel through the voice channel, and Internet signals pass through the other channel. This way, you can use  
the same line for analog voice calls (including faxes) and digital Internet access.  
To minimize interference between the two channels and ensure a quality connection, you need to install a DSL filter  
for the analog devices (fax machine, telephone, answering machine) in your network. Interference causes noise and  
static on the telephone, failed and poor quality faxes for the printer, and slow Internet connection on your computer.  
Note: Contact your DSL provider to obtain a DSL filter.  
To install a filter for the printer:  
1 Connect the line port of the DSL filter to the wall jack.  
2 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with your printer to the port of the printer. Connect the other  
end to the phone port on the DSL filter.  
3 To connect a telephone to the printer, remove any installed adapter plug from the  
port of the printer, and then  
connect the telephone to the port.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Faxing  
75  
Scenario 3: VoIP telephone service  
To connect:  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with the printer to the port of the printer.  
2 Connect the other end of the cable to the port labeled Phone Line 1 or Phone Port on the VoIP adapter.  
Note: The port labeled Phone Line 2 or Fax Port is not always active. VoIP providers may charge additional cost  
for activation of the second phone port.  
3 Connect the telephone to the  
port of the printer.  
Tips for this setup:  
To make sure that the phone port on the VoIP adapter is active, plug an analog telephone into the phone port, and  
then listen for a dial tone. If you hear a dial tone, then the port is active.  
If you need two phone ports for your devices, but do not want to pay additional cost, then do not plug the printer  
into the second phone port. You can use a phone splitter. Plug the phone splitter into the port labeled Phone Line  
1 or Phone Port, and then plug the printer and telephone into the splitter.  
Note: Make sure you use a phone splitter, not a line splitter. To make sure that you are using the correct  
splitter, plug an analog telephone into the splitter and then listen for a dial tone.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Faxing  
76  
Scenario 4: Digital telephone service through a cable provider  
Setup 1: Printer is connected directly to a cable modem  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with your printer to the port of the printer.  
2 Connect the other end of the cable to the port labeled Phone Line 1 or Phone Port on the cable modem.  
Note: The port labeled Phone Line 2 or Fax Port is not always active. VoIP providers may charge additional cost  
for activation of the second phone port.  
3 Connect your analog telephone phone to the  
port of the printer.  
Notes:  
To make sure that the telephone port on the cable modem is active, plug an analog telephone into the  
telephone port, and then listen for a dial tone. If you hear a dial tone, then the port is active.  
If you need two telephone ports for your devices, but do not want to pay additional cost, then do not plug the  
printer into the second telephone port. You can use a phone splitter. Plug the phone splitter into the Phone Line  
1 or Phone Port, and then plug the printer and telephone into the splitter.  
Make sure you use a phone splitter, not a line splitter. To make sure that you are using the correct splitter, plug  
an analog telephone into the splitter and then listen for a dial tone.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Faxing  
77  
Setup 2: Printer is connected to a wall jack; cable modem is installed elsewhere in the facility  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with your printer to the port of the printer.  
2 Connect the other end of the telephone cable to an active analog telephone wall jack.  
3 Connect your analog telephone to the  
port of the printer.  
Scenario 5: Countries or regions with different telephone wall jacks and plugs  
Some countries or regions may have different types of telephone wall jack connectors than those that came with the  
printer. The standard wall jack adopted by most countries or regions is RJ-11. Your printer comes with the RJ-11 jack  
and a telephone cable with the RJ-11 plug.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Faxing  
78  
If the wall jack or equipment in your facility is not compatible with this type of connection, then you need to use a  
telephone adapter. An adapter for your country or region may not come with your printer, and you may need to  
purchase it separately.  
There may be an adapter plug installed in the  
that has a cascaded or serial wiring scheme, then do not remove the adapter plug from the  
port of the printer. If you are using a telephone adapter or a facility  
port of the printer.  
Part name  
Part number  
Lexmark adapter plug  
40X8519  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Faxing  
79  
Connecting the printer to a nonRJ11 wall jack  
LINE  
EXT  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with printer to the port of the printer.  
2 Connect the other end of the cable to the RJ11 adapter, and then connect the adapter to the wall jack.  
3 If you want to connect another device (telephone or answering machine) to the same wall jack, and if the device  
has a nonRJ11 connector, then connect it directly to the telephone adapter.  
Notes:  
The  
port of the printer may have an adapter plug for use with the adapter. Do not remove the plug from  
the  
port of the printer.  
In some countries or regions, the printer may not come with a telephone adapter or an adapter plug.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Faxing  
80  
Connecting the printer to a wall jack in Germany  
The German wall jack has two kinds of ports. The N ports are for fax machines, modems, and answering machines. The  
F port is for telephones.  
N F N  
Connect the printer to any of the N ports.  
N
F
N
PHONE  
LINE  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Faxing  
81  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came the printer to the port of the printer.  
2 Connect the other end of the telephone cable to the RJ11 adapter, and then connect the adapter to an N port.  
3 If you want to connect a telephone and answering machine to the same wall jack, then connect the devices as  
shown.  
Note: Do not remove the adapter plug from the  
port of the printer if you are connecting to a serial or cascaded  
telephone system.  
Connecting to a distinctive ring service  
A distinctive ring service may be available from your telephone company. This service lets you have multiple telephone  
numbers on one telephone line, with each telephone number having a different ring pattern. This may be useful for  
distinguishing between fax and voice calls. If you subscribe to a distinctive ring service, then follow these steps to  
connect the equipment:  
1 Connect one end of the telephone cable that came with the printer to the printer LINE port  
.
2 Connect the other end of the telephone cable to an active analog telephone wall jack.  
3 Change the Distinctive Rings setting to match the setting you want the printer to answer.  
From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings >  
> Fax Settings >  
> Distinctive Rings > select the ring tone you want >  
Setting the outgoing fax or station name and number  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Fax Settings > Analog Fax Setup.  
3 From the Fax Settings menu, type the name to be printed on all outgoing faxes in the Fax Name or Station Name  
field.  
4 In the Fax Number or Station Number field, enter the printer fax number.  
5 Click Submit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Faxing  
82  
Setting the date and time  
You can set the date and time so that they are printed on every fax you send. If there is a power failure, then you may  
have to reset the date and time.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Other Settings area > Security > Set Date and Time.  
3 In the Set Date & Time field, enter the current date and time.  
4 Click Submit.  
Note: We recommend using the network time.  
Configuring the printer to observe daylight saving time  
Set the printer to automatically adjust for daylight saving time.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Security > Set Date and Time.  
3 Select the Automatically Observe DST check box, and then enter the DST start and end dates in the Custom Time  
Zone Setup section.  
4 Click Submit.  
Sending a fax  
Sending a fax using the printer control panel  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Faxing  
83  
3 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Fax >  
Note: If you want to fax another document, then place it on the scanner glass, press the left or right arrow  
button to scroll to Scan the Next Page, and then press  
> enter a fax or shortcut number on the keypad >  
> Original Size >  
.
4 Press the left or right arrow button to scroll to Finish the Job, and then press  
.
Sending a fax using the computer  
1 With a document open, click File > Print.  
2 Select the printer, and then click Properties, Preferences, Options, or Setup.  
3 Navigate to:  
Fax > Enable fax  
4 Enter the recipient fax number or numbers.  
5 If necessary, enter a prefix in the “Dialing prefix” field.  
6 Select the appropriate paper size and page orientation, and then apply the changes.  
Notes:  
The fax option is available for use only with the PostScript driver or the Universal Fax Driver. For information on  
installing these drivers, go to http://support.lexmark.com.  
The fax option must be configured and enabled in the PostScript driver under the Configuration tab before it can  
be used.  
Sending a fax using a shortcut number  
Fax shortcuts are just like the speed dial numbers on a telephone or fax machine. A shortcut number (1–999) can contain  
a single recipient or multiple recipients.  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 Press # , and then enter the shortcut number on the keypad.  
4 Press  
.
Sending a fax at a scheduled time  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Faxing  
84  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly into the ADF tray.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Fax >  
sent >  
> enter the fax number > Delayed Send > Send Later > select the date you want the fax to be  
> select the time you want the fax to be sent >  
4 Press  
.
Note: The document is scanned, and then faxed at the scheduled time.  
Creating a fax destination shortcut using the Embedded Web  
Server  
Assign a shortcut number to a single fax number or a group of fax numbers.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Manage Shortcuts > Fax Shortcut Setup.  
Note: A password may be required. If you do not have an ID and password, then contact your system support  
person.  
3 Type a name for the shortcut, and then enter the fax number.  
Notes:  
To create a multiplenumber shortcut, enter the fax numbers for the group.  
Separate each fax number in the group with a semicolon (;).  
4 Assign a shortcut number.  
Note: If you enter a number that is already in use, then you are prompted to select another number.  
5 Click Add.  
Customizing fax settings  
Changing the fax resolution  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Faxing  
85  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Fax >  
> enter the fax number > Resolution > select the resolution you want  
Note: You can choose from Standard (fastest speed) to Ultra Fine (slowest speed and best quality).  
4 Press  
.
Making a fax lighter or darker  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
Fax >  
> enter the fax number >  
> Darkness > adjust the darkness of the fax >  
Viewing a fax log  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Reports.  
3 Click Fax Job Log or Fax Call Log.  
Blocking junk faxes  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Faxing  
86  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Fax Settings > Analog Fax Setup > Block No Name Fax.  
Notes:  
This option blocks all incoming faxes that have a private caller ID or no fax name.  
In the Banned Fax List field, enter the phone numbers or fax names of specific fax callers you want to block.  
Canceling an outgoing fax  
Canceling a fax job while the original documents are still scanning  
If you are using the ADF tray and Scanning pageappears, then press  
If you are using the scanner glass and Scanning page, Scan the Next Page, or Finish the Job  
appears, then press  
.
.
Canceling a fax job after scanning the original documents  
1 From the printer control panel, press  
.
2 Press the left or right arrow button to scroll to the job you want to cancel.  
3 Press  
> Delete Selected Jobs.  
Holding and forwarding faxes  
Holding faxes  
This option lets you hold received faxes from printing until they are released. Held faxes can be released manually or  
at a scheduled day or time.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Fax Settings > Analog Fax Setup > Holding Faxes.  
3 From the Held Fax Mode menu, select Off, Always On, Manual, or Scheduled.  
4 If you selected Scheduled, then continue with the following steps:  
a Click Fax Holding Schedule.  
b From the Action menu, select Hold faxes.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Faxing  
87  
c From the Time menu, select the time you want the held faxes released.  
d From the Day(s) menu, select the day you want the held faxes released.  
5 Click Add.  
Forwarding a fax  
This option lets you print and forward received faxes to a fax number, email address, FTP site, or LDSS.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Fax Settings.  
3 From the Fax Forwarding menu, select Print, Print and Forward, or Forward.  
4 From the “Forward to” menu, select Fax, Email, FTP, LDSS, or eSF.  
5 In the “Forward to Shortcut” field, enter the shortcut number where you want the fax forwarded.  
Note: The shortcut number must be valid for the setting selected in the “Forward to” menu.  
6 Click Submit.  
Understanding the fax options  
Original Size  
This option lets you choose the size of the documents you are going to fax.  
1 From the Fax area of the printer control panel, press the Options button.  
Original Sizeappears.  
2 Press  
.
3 Press the arrow buttons until the size of the original document appears, and then press  
.
Resolution  
This option lets you adjust the quality of the fax output. Increasing the image resolution increases the file size and the  
time needed to scan your original document. Decreasing the image resolution reduces the file size.  
Select one of the following:  
Standard—Use this when faxing most documents.  
Fine 200 dpi—Use this when faxing documents with small prints.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Faxing  
88  
Super fine 300 dpi—Use this when faxing documents with fine details.  
Ultra fine 600 dpi—Use this when faxing documents with pictures or photos.  
Darkness  
This option lets you adjust how light or dark the faxes are in relation to the original document.  
Content Type  
This option lets you set the original document type.  
Select from the following content types:  
Graphics—The original document is mostly businesstype graphics, such as pie charts, bar charts, and animations.  
Photo—The original document is mostly a photo or an image.  
Text—The content of the original document is mostly text or line art.  
Text/Photo—The original document is a mixture of text, graphics, and photos.  
Content Source  
This option lets you set the original document source.  
Select from the following content sources:  
Color Laser—The original document was printed using a color laser printer.  
Black/White Laser—The original document was printed using a mono laser printer.  
Inkjet—The original document was printed using an inkjet printer.  
Photo/Film—The original document is a photo from a film.  
Magazine—The original document is from a magazine.  
Newspaper—The original document is from a newspaper.  
Press—The original document was printed using a printing press.  
Other—The original document was printed using an alternate or unknown printer.  
Sides (Duplex)  
This option informs the printer if the original document is simplex (printed on one side) or duplex (printed on both  
sides). This lets the scanner know what needs to be scanned for inclusion in the fax.  
Note: Duplex scanning is not available on selected printer models.  
Orientation  
This option lets you specify the orientation of the original document, and then change the Sides and Binding settings  
to match the orientation.  
Binding  
This option lets you specify if the original document is bound on the longedge or shortedge side.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Scanning  
89  
Scanning  
Scanning to an FTP address  
Automatic document feeder (ADF)  
Scanner glass  
Use the ADF for multiplepage documents.  
Note: The ADF scans only one side of the sheet.  
Use the scanner glass for single-page documents, book pages, small items  
(such as postcards or photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media  
(such as magazine clippings).  
The scanner lets you scan documents directly to a File Transfer Protocol (FTP) server. Only one FTP address may be  
sent to the server at a time.  
When an FTP destination has been configured by your system support person, the name of the destination becomes  
available as a shortcut number, or it is listed as a profile under the Held Jobs icon. An FTP destination could also be  
another PostScript printer.  
Creating shortcuts  
Creating an FTP shortcut using the Embedded Web Server  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Navigate to:  
Settings > Other Settings area > Manage Shortcuts > FTP Shortcut Setup  
3 Enter the appropriate information.  
Note: A password may be required. If you do not have an ID and password, then contact your system support  
person.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Scanning  
90  
4 Enter a shortcut number.  
If you enter a number that is already in use, then you are prompted to select another number.  
5 Click Add.  
Scanning to an FTP address  
Scanning to an FTP address using a shortcut number  
1 Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine  
clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded properly.  
2 If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
3 From the printer control panel, press #, and then enter the FTP shortcut number.  
4 Press  
.
Scanning to a computer  
Automatic document feeder (ADF)  
Scanner glass  
Use the ADF for multiplepage documents.  
Note: The ADF scans only one side of the sheet.  
Use the scanner glass for single-page documents, book pages, small items  
(such as postcards or photos), transparencies, photo paper, or thin media  
(such as magazine clippings).  
The scanner lets you scan documents directly to a computer. The computer does not have to be directly connected to  
the printer for you to receive Scan to PC images. You can scan the document back to the computer over the network  
by creating a scan profile on the computer and then downloading the profile to the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Scanning  
91  
Scanning to a computer  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Scan Profile > Create Scan Profile.  
3 Select your scan settings, and then click Next.  
4 Select a location on your computer where you want to save the scanned output file.  
5 Type a scan name.  
The scan name is the name that appears in the Scan Profile list on the display.  
6 Click Submit.  
7 Review the instructions on the Scan Profile screen.  
A shortcut number is automatically assigned when you click Submit. You can use this shortcut number when you  
are ready to scan your documents.  
a Load an original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray or facedown on the scanner glass.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies, photo paper, or thin media (such as  
magazine clippings) into the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light turns on when the paper is loaded properly.  
b If you are loading a document into the ADF tray, then adjust the paper guides.  
c From the printer control panel, press #, and then type the shortcut number using the keypad, or press the up  
or down arrow button to scroll to Held Jobs, and then press the up or down arrow button to scroll to Profiles.  
After entering the shortcut number, the scanner scans and sends the document to the directory or program  
you specified. If you selected Profiles on the printer control panel, then locate your shortcut on the list.  
8 View the file from the computer.  
The output file is saved in the location or launched in the program you specified.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
92  
Understanding the printer menus  
Menus list  
Paper Menu  
Reports  
Network/Ports  
Security  
Settings  
Default Source  
Paper Size/Type  
Configure MP  
Substitute Size  
Paper Texture  
Paper Weight  
Paper Loading  
Custom Types  
Custom Scan Sizes  
Universal Setup  
Menu Settings Page  
Device Statistics  
Network Setup Page1 SMTP Setup  
Active NIC  
Standard Network2  
Confidential Print  
Security Audit Log  
Set Date and Time  
General Settings  
Copy Settings  
Fax Settings  
Email Settings  
FTP Settings  
Shortcut List  
Fax Job Log  
Print Settings  
Fax Call Log  
Copy Shortcuts  
E-mail Shortcuts  
Fax Shortcuts  
FTP Shortcuts  
Profiles List  
Print Fonts  
Asset Report  
Help  
Manage Shortcuts  
Print All Guides  
Copy Guide  
Fax Shortcuts  
E-mail Shortcuts  
FTP Shortcuts  
Copy Shortcuts  
Profile Shortcuts  
E-mail Guide  
Fax Guide  
FTP Guide  
Print Defects Guide  
Information Guide  
Supplies Guide  
1 Depending on the printer setup, this menu item appears as Network Setup Page or Network [x] Setup Page.  
2 Depending on the printer setup, this menu item appears as Standard Network or Network [x].  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
93  
Paper menu  
Default Source menu  
Use  
To  
Default Source  
Tray [x]  
Set a default paper source for all print jobs.  
Notes:  
MP Feeder  
Manual Paper  
Manual Envelope  
Tray 1 (standard tray) is the factory default setting.  
From the Paper menu, set Configure MP to “Cassette” for MP Feeder to  
appear as a menu setting.  
If the same size and type of paper are in two trays and the paper size and  
paper type settings match, then the trays are automatically linked. When  
one tray is empty, the print job continues using the linked tray.  
Paper Size/Type menu  
Use  
To  
Tray [x] Size  
A4  
Specify the size of the paper loaded in each tray.  
Notes:  
A5  
A6  
JIS B5  
Letter  
Letter is the U.S. factory default setting. A4 is the international factory  
default setting.  
If the same size and type of paper are loaded in two trays and the tray  
settings for paper size and type match, then the trays are automatically  
linked. The multipurpose feeder may also be linked. When one tray is  
empty, the job prints using paper from the linked tray.  
Legal  
Executive  
Oficio (Mexico)  
Folio  
A6 is supported only in Tray 1 and in the multipurpose feeder.  
Statement  
Universal  
Tray [x] Type  
Plain Paper  
Transparency  
Recycled  
Specify the type of the paper loaded in each tray.  
Notes:  
Plain Paper is the factory default setting for Tray 1. Custom Type [x] is  
the factory default setting for all other trays.  
Labels  
Bond  
If available, a userdefined name will appear instead of Custom Type [x].  
Use this menu to configure automatic tray linking.  
Letterhead  
Preprinted  
Colored Paper  
Light Paper  
Heavy Paper  
Rough/Cotton  
Custom Type [x]  
Note: Only installed trays and feeders are listed in this menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Understanding the printer menus  
94  
Use  
To  
MP Feeder Size  
A4  
Specify the size of the paper loaded in the multipurpose feeder.  
Notes:  
A5  
A6  
JIS B5  
Letter  
Letter is the U.S. factory default setting. A4 is the international factory  
default setting.  
From the Paper menu, set Configure MP to “Cassette” for MP Feeder  
Size to appear as a menu item.  
Legal  
The multipurpose feeder does not automatically detect paper size. The  
paper size value must be set.  
Executive  
Oficio (Mexico)  
Folio  
Statement  
Universal  
7 3/4 Envelope  
9 Envelope  
10 Envelope  
DL Envelope  
C5 Envelope  
B5 Envelope  
Other Envelope  
MP Feeder Type  
Plain Paper  
Card Stock  
Specify the type of the paper loaded in the multipurpose feeder.  
Notes:  
Plain Paper is the factory default setting.  
Transparency  
Recycled  
Labels  
From the Paper menu, set Configure MP to “Cassette” in order for MP  
Feeder Type to appear as a menu item.  
Bond  
Envelope  
Rough Envelope  
Letterhead  
Preprinted  
Colored Paper  
Light Paper  
Heavy Paper  
Rough/Cotton  
Custom Type [x]  
Note: Only installed trays and feeders are listed in this menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
95  
Use  
To  
Manual Paper Size  
A4  
Specify the size of the paper being manually loaded.  
Note: Letter is the U.S. factory default setting. A4 is the international factory  
A5  
default setting.  
A6  
JIS B5  
Letter  
Legal  
Executive  
Oficio (Mexico)  
Folio  
Statement  
Universal  
Manual Paper Type  
Plain Paper  
Card Stock  
Specify the type of the paper being manually loaded.  
Notes:  
Plain Paper is the factory default setting.  
Transparency  
Recycled  
Labels  
From the Paper menu, set Configure MP to “Manual” in order for  
Manual Paper Type to appear as a menu item.  
Bond  
Letterhead  
Preprinted  
Colored Paper  
Light Paper  
Heavy Paper  
Rough/Cotton  
Custom Type [x]  
Manual Envelope Size  
7 3/4 Envelope  
9 Envelope  
Specify the size of the envelope being manually loaded.  
Note: 10 Envelope is the U.S. factory default setting. DL Envelope is the  
international factory default setting.  
10 Envelope  
DL Envelope  
C5 Envelope  
B5 Envelope  
Other Envelope  
Manual Envelope Type  
Envelope  
Specify the type of the envelope being manually loaded.  
Note: Envelope is the factory default setting.  
Rough Envelope  
Custom Type [x]  
Note: Only installed trays and feeders are listed in this menu.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
96  
Configure MP menu  
Use  
To  
Configure MP  
Cassette  
Manual  
Determine when the printer selects paper from the multipurpose feeder.  
Notes:  
Cassette is the factory default setting. Cassette configures the  
multipurpose feeder as the automatic paper source.  
First  
Manual sets the multipurpose feeder only for manualfeed print jobs.  
First configures the multipurpose feeder as the primary paper source.  
Substitute Size menu  
Use  
To  
Substitute Size  
Off  
Substitute a specified paper size if the requested paper size is not available.  
Notes:  
Statement/A5  
Letter/A4  
All Listed  
All Listed is the factory default setting. All available substitutions are  
allowed.  
Off indicates that no size substitutions are allowed.  
Setting a size substitution lets the print job continue without Change  
Paperappearing.  
Paper Texture menu  
Use  
To  
Plain Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the plain paper loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Card Stock Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the card stock loaded.  
Notes:  
Normal  
Rough  
Normal is the factory default setting.  
The options appear only if card stock is supported.  
Transparency Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the transparencies loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Recycled Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the recycled paper loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Understanding the printer menus  
97  
Use  
To  
Labels Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the labels loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Bond Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the bond paper loaded.  
Note: Rough is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Envelope Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the envelopes loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Rough Envelope Texture  
Specify the relative texture of the rough envelopes loaded.  
Rough  
Letterhead Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the letterhead loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Preprinted Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the preprinted paper loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Colored Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the colored paper loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Light Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the paper loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Heavy Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the paper loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Rough  
Rough/Cotton Texture  
Specify the relative texture of the cotton paper loaded.  
Rough  
Custom [x] Texture  
Smooth  
Specify the relative texture of the custom paper loaded.  
Notes:  
Normal  
Rough  
Normal is the factory default setting.  
The options appear only if the custom type is supported.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
98  
Paper Weight menu  
Use  
To  
Plain Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the plain paper loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Card Stock Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the card stock loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Transparency Weight  
Specify the relative weight of the transparencies loaded.  
Light  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Recycled Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the recycled paper loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Labels Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the labels loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Bond Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the bond paper loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Envelope Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the envelope loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Rough Envelope Weight  
Specify the relative weight of the rough envelope loaded.  
Light  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Letterhead Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the letterhead loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Preprinted Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the preprinted paper loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
99  
Use  
To  
Colored Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the colored paper loaded.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Light Weight  
Specify that the relative weight of the paper loaded is light.  
Specify the relative weight of the paper loaded is heavy.  
Light  
Heavy Weight  
Heavy  
Rough/Cotton Weight  
Specify the relative weight of the cotton or rough paper loaded.  
Light  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting.  
Normal  
Heavy  
Custom [x] Weight  
Light  
Specify the relative weight of the custom paper loaded.  
Notes:  
Normal  
Heavy  
Normal is the factory default setting.  
The options appear only when the custom type is supported.  
Paper Loading menu  
Use  
To  
Recycled Loading  
Determine and set twosided printing for all print jobs that specify  
Recycled as the paper type.  
Duplex  
Off  
Bond Loading  
Duplex  
Determine and set twosided printing for all print jobs that specify  
Bond as the paper type.  
Off  
Letterhead Loading  
Determine and set twosided printing for all print jobs that specify  
Letterhead as the paper type.  
Duplex  
Off  
Preprinted Loading  
Determine and set twosided printing for all print jobs that specify  
Preprinted as the paper type.  
Duplex  
Off  
Colored Loading  
Duplex  
Determine and set twosided printing for all print jobs that specify  
Colored as the paper type.  
Off  
Notes:  
Duplex sets twosided printing as the default for all print jobs unless onesided printing is set from Printing  
Preferences or Print dialog.  
If Duplex is selected, then all print jobs are sent through the duplex unit, including onesided jobs.  
Off is the factory default setting for all the menus.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
100  
Use  
To  
Light Loading  
Duplex  
Determine and set twosided printing for all print jobs that specify  
Light as the paper type.  
Off  
Heavy Loading  
Duplex  
Determine and set twosided printing for all print jobs that specify  
Heavy as the paper type.  
Off  
Custom [x] Loading  
Determine and set twosided printing for all print jobs that specify  
Custom [x] as the paper type.  
Duplex  
Off  
Note: Custom [x] Loading is available only if the custom type is  
supported.  
Notes:  
Duplex sets twosided printing as the default for all print jobs unless onesided printing is set from Printing  
Preferences or Print dialog.  
If Duplex is selected, then all print jobs are sent through the duplex unit, including onesided jobs.  
Off is the factory default setting for all the menus.  
Custom Types menu  
Use  
To  
Custom Type [x]  
Paper  
Associatea paper or specialty media type with a factory default Custom Type [x]  
name or a userdefined custom name created in the Embedded Web Server or  
MarkVisionTM Professional. The userdefined name appears instead of Custom  
Type [x].  
Card Stock  
Transparency  
Rough/Cotton  
Labels  
Notes:  
Paper is the factory default setting for Custom Type [x].  
Envelope  
The custom media type must be supported in the selected tray or feeder  
in order to print from that source.  
Recycled  
Paper  
Specify a paper type when the Recycled setting is selected in other menus.  
Notes:  
Card Stock  
Transparency  
Rough/Cotton  
Labels  
Paper is the factory default setting.  
The Recycled paper type must be supported in the selected tray or  
feeder in order to print from that source.  
Envelope  
Cotton  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
101  
Custom Scan Sizes menu  
Use  
To  
Custom Scan Size [x]  
Scan Size Name  
Width  
Specify a custom scan size name and page orientation.  
Notes:  
The custom scan size name replaces Custom Scan Size [x] in the printer  
menus.  
Height  
Orientation  
Portrait  
Landscape  
2 scans per side  
Off  
ADF Media Type is the factory default setting for custom scan sizes 3, 4,  
5, and 6.  
8.5 inches is the U.S. factory default setting for Width. 210 millimeters is  
the international factory default setting for Width.  
14 inches is the U.S. factory default setting for Height. 297 millimeters is  
the international factory default setting for Height.  
On  
Portrait is the factory default setting for Orientation.  
Off is the factory default setting for “2 scans per side.”  
Universal Setup menu  
Use  
To  
Units of Measure  
Inches  
Identify the units of measure.  
Notes:  
Millimeters  
Inches is the US factory default setting.  
Millimeters is the international factory default setting.  
Portrait Width  
3–8.5 inches  
76–216 mm  
Set the portrait width.  
Notes:  
If the width exceeds the maximum, then the printer uses the  
maximum width allowed.  
8.5 inches is the US factory default setting. You can increase the  
width in 0.01inch increments.  
216 mm is the international factory default setting. You can increase  
the width in 1mm increments.  
Portrait Height  
3–14.17 inches  
76–360 mm  
Set the portrait height.  
Notes:  
If the height exceeds the maximum, then the printer uses the  
maximum height allowed.  
14 inches is the US factory default setting. You can increase the  
height in 0.01inch increments.  
356 mm is the international factory default setting. You can increase  
the height in 1mm increments.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
102  
Use  
To  
Feed Direction  
Short Edge  
Specify the feed direction if the paper can be loaded in either direction.  
Notes:  
Long Edge  
Short Edge is the factory default setting.  
Long Edge appears only when the longest edge is shorter than the  
maximum width supported in the tray.  
Reports menu  
Reports menu  
Use  
To  
Menu Settings Page  
Print a report containing information about the paper loaded into trays, installed  
memory, total page count, alarms, timeouts, printer control panel language,  
TCP/IP address, status of supplies, status of the network connection, and other  
information.  
Device Statistics  
Print a report containing printer statistics such as supply information and details  
about printed pages.  
Network Setup Page  
Print a report containing information about the network printer settings, such as  
the TCP/IP address information.  
Note: This menu item appears only in network printers or printers connected  
to print servers.  
Shortcut List  
Fax Job Log  
Print a report containing information about configured shortcuts.  
Print a report containing information about the last 200 completed faxes.  
Note: This menu item is available only when Enable Job Log is set to On in the  
Fax Settings menu.  
Fax Call Log  
Print a report containing information about the last 100 attempted, received, and  
blocked calls.  
Note: This menu item is available only when Enable Job Log is set to On in the  
Fax Settings menu.  
Copy Shortcuts  
Email Shortcuts  
Fax Shortcuts  
FTP Shortcuts  
Profiles List  
Print a report containing information about copy shortcuts.  
Print a report containing information about email shortcuts.  
Print a report containing information about fax shortcuts.  
Print a report containing information about FTP shortcuts.  
Print a list of profiles stored in the printer.  
Print Fonts  
Print a report of all the fonts available for the printer language currently set in  
the printer.  
Asset Report  
Print a report containing asset information including the printer serial number  
and model name. The report contains text and UPC bar codes that can be scanned  
into an asset database.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
103  
Network/Ports menu  
Active NIC menu  
Use  
To  
Notes:  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
This menu item appears only when an optional network card is installed.  
Active NIC  
Auto  
[list of available network cards]  
Standard Network or Network [x] menu  
Note: Only active ports appear in this menu. All inactive ports are omitted.  
Use  
To  
PCL SmartSwitch  
Set the printer to automatically switch to PCL emulation when a print job requires  
it, regardless of the default printer language.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
If PCL SmartSwitch is disabled, then the printer does not examine incoming  
data and it uses the default printer language specified in the Setup menu.  
PS SmartSwitch  
Set the printer to automatically switch to PS emulation when a print job requires it,  
regardless of the default printer language.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
If PS SmartSwitch is disabled, then the printer does not examine incoming  
data and uses the default printer language specified in the Setup menu.  
NPA Mode  
Off  
Set the printer to perform the special processing required for bidirectional  
communication following the conventions defined by the NPA protocol.  
Auto  
Notes:  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Understanding the printer menus  
104  
Use  
To  
Network Buffer  
Auto  
Set the size of the network input buffer.  
Notes:  
3KB to [maximum size allowed]  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
The value can be changed in 1KB increments.  
The maximum size allowed depends on the amount of memory in the printer,  
the size of the other link buffers, and whether Resource Save is set to On or  
Off.  
To increase the maximum size range for the Network Buffer, disable or  
reduce the size of the parallel, serial, and USB buffers.  
Changing this setting from the printer control panel, and then exiting the  
menus causes the printer to restart. The menu selection is then updated.  
Mac Binary PS  
Set the printer to process Macintosh binary PostScript print jobs.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Auto is the factory default setting.  
Auto  
Off filters print jobs using the standard protocol.  
On processes raw binary PostScript print jobs.  
Standard Network Setup or  
Display and set the printer network settings.  
Network [x] Setup  
Note: The Wireless menu appears only when the printer is connected to a wireless  
network.  
Reports  
Network Card  
TCP/IP  
IPv6  
Wireless  
AppleTalk  
Reports menu  
To access the menu, navigate to either of the following:  
Network/Ports > Standard Network > Standard Network Setup > Reports  
Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > Reports  
Use  
To  
Print Setup Page Print a report containing information about the network printer settings, such as the TCP/IP address.  
Network Card menu  
To access the menu, navigate to either of the following:  
Network/Ports > Standard Network > Standard Network Setup > Network Card  
Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > Network Card  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
105  
Use  
To  
View Card Status  
Connected  
View the connection status of the wireless network adapter.  
Disconnected  
View Card Speed  
View the speed of an active wireless network adapter.  
View the network addresses.  
Network Address  
UAA  
LAA  
Job Timeout  
Set the amount of time it takes for a network print job to be canceled.  
0, 10–225 seconds  
Notes:  
“90 seconds” is the factory default setting.  
A setting value of 0 disables the timeout.  
If a value between 1 and 9 is selected, then Invalidappears on the  
display, and the value is not saved.  
Banner Page  
Allow the printer to print a banner page.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
TCP/IP menu  
To access the menu, navigate to either of the following:  
Network/Ports > Standard Network > Standard Network Setup > TCP/IP  
Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > TCP/IP  
Note: This menu is available only in network printers or printers attached to print servers.  
Use  
To  
Set Hostname  
Set the current TCP/IP host name.  
Note: This can be changed only from the Embedded Web Server.  
IP Address  
View or change the current TCP/IP address.  
Note: Manually setting the IP address sets the Enable DHCP and Enable Auto IP  
settings to Off. It also sets Enable BOOTP and Enable RARP to Off on systems that  
support BOOTP and RARP.  
Netmask  
Gateway  
View or change the current TCP/IP netmask.  
View or change the current TCP/IP gateway.  
Enable DHCP  
Specify the DHCP address and parameter assignment.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Enable RARP  
Specify the RARP address assignment setting.  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
106  
Use  
To  
Enable BOOTP  
Specify the BOOTP address assignment setting.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Enable AutoIP  
Specify the Zero Configuration Networking setting.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
Enable FTP/TFTP  
Enable the built-in FTP server, which lets you send files to the printer using File Transfer  
Protocol.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
Enable HTTP Server  
Enable the built-in Web server (Embedded Web Server). When enabled, the printer  
can be monitored and managed remotely using a Web browser.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
WINS Server Address  
View or change the current WINS server address.  
Enable DDNS  
View or change the current DDNS setting.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
Enable mDNS  
View or change the current mDNS setting.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
DNS Server Address  
View or change the current DNS server address.  
View or change the backup DNS server addresses.  
Backup DNS Server Address  
Backup DNS Server Address 2  
Backup DNS Server Address 3  
Enable HTTPS  
View or change the current HTTPS setting.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
IPv6 menu  
To access the menu, navigate to either of the following:  
Network/Ports > Standard Network > Standard Network Setup > IPv6  
Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > IPv6  
Note: This menu is available only in network printers or printers that are attached to print servers.  
Use  
To  
Enable IPv6  
Enable IPv6 in the printer.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
107  
Use  
To  
Auto Configuration  
Specify whether or not the wireless network adapter accepts the  
automatic IPv6 address configuration entries provided by a router.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
View Hostname  
View Address  
Set the host name.  
Note: These settings can be changed only from the Embedded Web  
Server.  
View Router Address  
Enable DHCPv6  
Enable DHCPv6 in the printer.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Wireless menu  
Note: This menu is available only in printers connected to an Ethernet network and printers with a wireless network  
adapter attached.  
To access the menu, navigate to either of the following:  
Network/Ports > Standard Network > Standard Network Setup > Wireless  
Network/Ports > Network [x] > Network [x] Setup > Wireless  
Use  
To  
WiFi Protected Setup (WPS)  
Start Push Button Method  
Start PIN Method  
Establish a wireless network connection and enable network security.  
Notes:  
Start Push Button Method connects the printer to a wireless  
network when buttons on both the printer and the access point  
(wireless router) are pressed within a given period of time.  
Start PIN Method connects the printer to a wireless network when  
a PIN on the printer is entered into the wireless settings of the  
access point.  
Enable/Disable WPS Autodetection  
Automatically detect the connection method that an access point with  
WPS uses—Start Push Button Method or Start PIN Method.  
Enable  
Disable  
Note: Disable is the factory default setting.  
Specify the network mode.  
Notes:  
Network Mode  
BSS Type  
Infrastructure  
Ad hoc  
Infrastructure is the factory default setting. This lets the printer  
access a network using an access point.  
Ad hoc configures a wireless connection directly between the  
printer and a computer.  
Compatibility  
802.11b/g  
Specify the wireless standard for the wireless network.  
Note: The 802.11b/g/n is the factory default setting.  
802.11b/g/n  
Choose Network  
Select an available network for the printer to use.  
View the quality of the wireless connection.  
View Signal Quality  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
108  
Use  
To  
View Security Mode  
View the encryption method for the wireless network.  
AppleTalk menu  
Note: This menu is available only in printer models connected to a wired network or when an optional network card  
is installed.  
To access the menu, navigate to any of the following:  
Network/Ports > Standard Network > Standard Network Setup > AppleTalk  
Network/Ports > Network Setup [x] > AppleTalk  
Use  
To  
Activate  
Yes  
Enable or disable AppleTalk support.  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
No  
View Name  
View Address  
Set Zone  
Show the assigned AppleTalk name.  
Note: The name can be changed only from the Embedded Web Server.  
Show the assigned AppleTalk address.  
Note: The address can be changed only from the Embedded Web Server.  
Provide a list of AppleTalk zones available on the network.  
[list of zones available on the network]  
Note: The factory default setting is the default zone for the network. If no  
default zone exists, then the zone marked with an asterisk (*) is the default  
setting.  
SMTP Setup menu  
Use  
To  
Primary SMTP Gateway  
Primary SMTP Gateway Port  
Secondary SMTP Gateway  
Secondary SMTP Gateway Port  
Specify SMTP server gateway and port information.  
Note: 25 is the default SMTP gateway port.  
SMTP Timeout  
Specify the amount of time in seconds before the server stops trying to  
send an email.  
5–30  
Note: 30 seconds is the factory default setting.  
Reply Address  
Specify a reply address of up to 128 characters in the e-mail sent by the  
printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
109  
Use  
To  
Use SSL  
Set the printer to use SSL for increased security when connecting to the  
SMTP server.  
Disabled  
Negotiate  
Required  
Notes:  
Disabled is the factory default setting.  
When the Negotiate setting is used, the SMTP server determines if  
SSL will be used.  
SMTP Server Authentication  
No authentication required  
Login/Plain  
Specify the type of user authentication required for scan to email  
privileges.  
Note: “No authentication required” is the factory default setting.  
CRAMMD5  
DigestMD5  
NTLM  
Kerberos 5  
DeviceInitiated Email  
None  
Specify what credentials will be used when communicating to the SMTP  
server.  
Use Device SMTP Credentials  
Notes:  
Device Userid  
None is the factory default setting for DeviceInitiated Email.  
Device Password  
Device Userid and Device Password are used to log in to the SMTP  
server when Use Device SMTP Credentials is selected.  
Security menu  
Security Audit Log menu  
Use  
To  
Export Log  
Let an authorized user export the audit log.  
Notes:  
To export the audit log from the printer control panel, a flash drive must be  
attached to the printer.  
The audit log can be downloaded from the Embedded Web Server and saved  
on a computer.  
Delete Log  
Yes  
Specify whether or not audit logs are deleted.  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
No  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
110  
Use  
To  
Configure Log  
Specify how and whether or not audit logs are created.  
Enable Audit  
Notes:  
Yes  
Enable Audit determines if events are recorded in the secure audit log and  
No  
remote syslog. No is the factory default setting.  
Enable Remote Syslog  
Enable Remote Syslog determines if logs are sent to a remote server. No is the  
factory default setting.  
No  
Yes  
Remote Syslog Facility determines the value used to send logs to the remote  
syslog server. 4 is the factory default setting.  
Remote Syslog Facility  
0–23  
If the security audit log is activated, then the severity value of each event is  
recorded. 4 is the factory default setting.  
Severity of events to log  
0–7  
Set Date and Time menu  
Use  
To  
Current Date and Time  
View the current date and time settings for the printer.  
Manually Set Date and Time  
Enter the date and time.  
[input date/time]  
Notes:  
Manually setting the date and time sets Enable NTP to No.  
The wizard lets you set the date and time in YYYYMMDDHH:MM format.  
Time Zone  
Select the time zone.  
[list of time zones]  
Note: GMT is the factory default settings.  
Automatically observe DST  
Set the printer to use the applicable daylight saving time (DST) start and end times  
associated with the printer Time Zone setting.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Enable NTP  
Enable Network Time Protocol, which synchronizes the clocks of devices on a  
network.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
This setting is turned off if you manually set the date and time.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
111  
Settings menu  
General Settings menu  
Use  
To  
Display Language  
English  
Set the language of the text appearing on the display.  
Note: Not all languages are available for all models. You may  
Francais  
need to install special hardware for some languages.  
Deutsch  
Italiano  
Espanol  
Dansk  
Norsk  
Nederlands  
Svenska  
Portuguese  
Suomi  
Russian  
Polski  
Greek  
Magyar  
Turkce  
Cesky  
Simplified Chinese  
Traditional Chinese  
Korean  
Japanese  
Show Supply Estimates  
Show estimates  
View the estimates of the supplies on the control panel, Embedded  
Web Server, menu settings, and device statistics reports.  
Do not show estimates  
Note: Show estimates is the factory default setting.  
Minimize the use of energy, paper, or specialty media.  
Notes:  
Eco-Mode  
Off  
Energy  
Energy/Paper  
Paper  
Off is the factory default setting. This resets the printer to its  
factory default settings.  
Energy minimizes the power used by the printer.  
Performance may be affected, but print quality is not.  
Energy/Paper minimizes the use of power, paper, and  
specialty media.  
Paper minimizes the amount of paper and specialty media  
needed for a print job. Performance may be affected, but  
print quality is not.  
ADF Loaded Beep  
Enabled  
Specify whether the ADF sounds a beep when paper is loaded.  
Note: Enabled is the factory default setting.  
Disabled  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
112  
Use  
To  
Quiet Mode  
Minimize the printer noise.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Run Initial setup  
Run the setup wizard.  
Yes  
No  
Paper Sizes  
US  
Specify the unit of measurement for paper sizes.  
Notes:  
Metric  
US is the factory default setting.  
The initial setting is determined by your country or region  
selection in the initial setup wizard.  
Scan to PC Port Range  
Specify a valid port range for printers behind a port blocking  
firewall.  
[port range]  
Note: 9751:12000 is the factory default setting.  
Home screen customization  
Change Language  
Copy  
Change the icons that appear on the home screen.  
For each icon, select from the following options:  
Display  
Fax  
Do not display  
Fax Shortcuts  
Email Shortcuts  
FTP Shortcuts  
Search Held Jobs  
Held Jobs  
Bookmarks  
Jobs by User  
One Page Copy  
Set copies from the scanner glass to only one page at a time.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Allow Background Removal  
Specify whether image background removal is allowed.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Allow Custom Job Scans  
Scan multiple jobs to one file.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting. If On is selected, then  
Allow Custom Job Scans settings can be enabled for specific jobs.  
Scanner Jam Recovery  
Job Level  
Specify how a scanned job should be reloaded if a paper jam occurs  
in the ADF.  
Page Level  
Note: Job Level is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
113  
Use  
To  
Alarms  
Set an alarm to sound when operator intervention is required.  
Alarm Control  
Cartridge Alarm  
For each alarm type, select from the following options:  
Off  
Single  
Continuous  
Notes:  
Single is the factory default setting for Alarm Control. This  
sounds several short beeps.  
Off is the factory default setting for Cartridge Alarm.  
Continuous repeats several short beeps at a regular interval.  
Timeouts  
Sleep Mode  
Disabled  
1–120  
Set the amountof time the printerwaitsafter a job is printedbefore  
it goes into a reduced power state.  
Notes:  
20 minutes is the factory default setting.  
Disabled appears only when Energy Conserve is set to Off.  
Lower settings conserve more energy, but may require  
longer warmup times.  
Select a high setting if the printer is in constant use. Under  
most circumstances, this keeps the printer ready to print.  
Timeouts  
Print a job while the display is off.  
Print with Display Off  
Allow printing with display off  
Display on when printing  
Note: Display on when printing is the factory default setting.  
Timeouts  
Hibernate Timeout  
Disabled  
Set the amount of time the printer waits before it enters Hibernate  
mode.  
Note: 3 days is the factory default setting.  
20 minutes  
1–3 hours  
6 hours  
1–3 days  
1–2 weeks  
1 month  
Timeouts  
Set the printer to hibernate mode when there is an active Ethernet  
connection.  
Hibernate Timeout on Connection  
Hibernate  
Note: Hibernate is the factory default setting.  
Do Not Hibernate  
Timeouts  
Set the amount of time before the display returns to a Ready state.  
Screen Timeout  
15–300  
Note: 30 seconds is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
114  
Use  
To  
Timeouts  
Print Timeout  
Disabled  
Set the amount of time the printer waits to receive an endofjob  
message before canceling the rest of the print job.  
Notes:  
1–255  
90 seconds is the factory default setting.  
When the timer expires, any partially printed page is printed,  
and then the printer checks to see if any new print jobs are  
waiting.  
Print Timeout is available only when using PCL emulation.  
Timeouts  
Wait Timeout  
Disabled  
Set the amount of time the printer waits for additional data before  
canceling a print job.  
Notes:  
15–65535  
40 seconds is the factory default setting.  
Wait Timeout is available only when the printer is using  
PostScript emulation.  
Error Recovery  
Auto Reboot  
Automatically reboot the printer.  
Note: Reboot always is the factory default setting.  
Reboot when idle  
Reboot always  
Reboot never  
Error Recovery  
Max Auto Reboots  
120  
Determine the number of automatic reboots the printer can  
perform.  
Notes:  
2 is the factory default setting.  
If the printer reaches the maximum number of reboots  
within a certain amount of time, the printer does not  
continue to reboot, and the error message appears on the  
display.  
Print Recovery  
Auto Continue  
Disabled  
Let the printer automatically continue printing from certain offline  
situations when these are not resolved within the specified time  
period.  
Note: Disabled is the factory default setting.  
5–255  
Print Recovery  
Specify whether the printer reprints jammed pages.  
Jam Recovery  
Notes:  
On  
Auto is the factory default setting. The printer reprints  
jammed pages unless the memory required to hold the  
pages is needed for other printer tasks.  
Off  
Auto  
On sets the printer to always reprint jammed pages.  
Off sets the printer to never reprint jammed pages.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
115  
Use  
To  
Print Recovery  
Set the printer to automatically check for jammed paper.  
Jam Assist  
On  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Off  
Print Recovery  
Page Protect  
Off  
Successfully print a page that may not have printed otherwise.  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting. This prints a partial page  
when there is not enough memory to print the whole page.  
On  
On sets the printer to print the entire page.  
Press Sleep Button  
Do Nothing  
Sleep  
Determine how the printer, while in idle state, reacts to a short  
press of the Sleep button.  
Note: Sleep is the factory default setting.  
Hibernate  
Press and Hold Sleep Button  
Do Nothing  
Determine how the printer, while in idle state, reacts to a long press  
of the Sleep button.  
Sleep  
Note: Do Nothing is the factory default setting.  
Hibernate  
Factory Defaults  
Do Not Restore  
Restore Now  
Restore the printer factory default settings.  
Notes:  
Do Not Restore is the factory default setting.  
Restore Now sets all printer settings to the factory default  
settings except for the Network/Ports menu settings. All  
downloads stored in the RAM are deleted.  
Custom Home Message  
Off  
Create a custom home message that appears during warnings,  
printer errors, and Home Prime/Status state.  
IP Address  
Hostname  
Contact Name  
Location  
Zero Configuration Name  
Custom Text [x]  
Copy Settings menu  
Use  
To  
Content Type  
Text  
Specify the content of the original document.  
Note: Text/Photo is the factory default setting.  
Graphics  
Text/Photo  
Photo  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
116  
Use  
To  
Content Source  
Black/White Laser  
Color Laser  
Inkjet  
Specify how the original document was produced.  
Note: Black/White Laser is the factory default setting.  
Photo/Film  
Magazine  
Newspaper  
Press  
Other  
Sides (Duplex)  
Specify whether an original document is twosided or onesided, and then specify  
whether the copy should be twosided or onesided.  
1 sided to 1 sided  
1 sided to 2 sided  
2 sided to 1 sided  
2 sided to 2 sided  
Notes:  
The ADF scans only one side of the sheet.  
1 sided to 1 sided—The original document has print on one side and the copy  
will also have print on one side.  
1 sided to 2 sided—The original document has print on one side, while the  
copy will have print on both sides.  
2 sided to 1 sided—The original document has print on both sides, while the  
copy will have print on just one side.  
2 sided to 2 sided—The original document has print on both sides, and the  
copy will also have print on both sides.  
Paper Saver  
Off  
Copy two or four sheets of a document on one page.  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
2up Portrait  
2up Landscape  
4up Portrait  
4up Landscape  
Print Page Borders  
Specify whether a border is printed.  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Collate  
Keep the pages of a print job stacked in sequence when printing multiple copies.  
(1,1,1) (2,2,2)  
(1,2,3) (1,2,3)  
Note: (1,2,3) (1,2,3) is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
117  
Use  
To  
Original Size  
Letter  
Specify the paper size of the original document.  
Notes:  
Legal  
Executive  
Folio  
Letter is the U.S. factory default setting.  
A4 is the international factory default setting.  
Statement  
Oficio (Mexico)  
Universal  
Auto Size Sense  
A4  
A5  
A6  
JIS B5  
Custom Scan Size [x]  
Book Original  
Business Card  
3 x 5 in.  
4 x 6 in.  
ID Card  
Copy To Source  
Tray [x]  
Specify the paper source for copy jobs.  
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.  
Auto Size Match  
MP Feeder  
Transparency Separators  
Place a sheet of paper between transparencies.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Separator Sheets  
Off  
Place a sheet of paper between pages, copies, or jobs.  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Between Copies  
Between Jobs  
Between Pages  
Separator Sheet Source  
Tray [x]  
Specify the paper source for the separator sheet.  
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.  
MP Feeder  
Darkness  
Lighten or darken the print on the copy.  
1–9  
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.  
Number of Copies  
Specify the number of copies for the copy job.  
1–999  
Note: 1 is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
118  
Use  
To  
Overlay  
Confidential  
Copy  
Specify the overlay text printed on each page of the copy job.  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Draft  
Urgent  
Custom  
Off  
Custom Overlay  
Specify the custom overlay text.  
Allow priority copies  
Allow interruption of a print job to copy a page or document.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Background Removal  
Adjust the amount of background visible on a copy.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Auto Center  
Automatically align the content at the center of the page.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Color Dropout  
Specify which color to drop and to adjust the dropout setting for each color threshold.  
Color Dropout  
Notes:  
None  
None is the factory default setting for Color Dropout.  
Red  
Green  
128 is the factory default setting for each color threshold.  
Blue  
Default Red Threshold  
0–255  
Default Green Threshold  
0–255  
Default Blue Threshold  
0–255  
Contrast  
0–5  
Specify the contrast used for the copy job.  
Note: Best for content is the factory default setting.  
Best for content  
Mirror Image  
Create a mirror image of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Negative Image  
Create a negative image of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Shadow Detail  
Adjust the amount of shadow detail visible on a copy.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
119  
Use  
To  
Adjust ADF Skew  
Correct slight skew in the scanned image.  
Auto  
Off  
Note: Auto is the factory default setting.  
On  
Scan edge to edge  
Specify if the original document is scanned edgetoedge.  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Off  
On  
Sharpness  
Adjust the amount of sharpness of a copy.  
1–5  
Note: 3 is the factory default setting.  
Fax Settings menu  
Fax Mode (Analog Fax Setup) menu  
Analog Fax Setup mode sends the fax job through a telephone line.  
General Fax Settings  
Use  
To  
Fax Name  
Fax Number  
Specify the name of the fax in the printer.  
Specify the number assigned to the fax.  
Fax ID  
Specify how the fax is identified.  
Fax Name  
Fax Number  
Note: Fax Number is the factory default setting.  
Enable Manual Fax  
Set the printer to fax manually, which requires a line splitter and a telephone handset.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Use a regular telephone to answer an incoming fax job and to dial a fax  
number.  
Press # 0 on the numeric keypad to go directly to the Manual Fax function.  
Define the allocation of non-volatile memory between sending and receiving fax jobs.  
Notes:  
Memory Use  
All receive  
Mostly receive  
Equal  
Equal is the factory default setting. This splits the memory for sending and  
receiving fax jobs into equal amounts.  
Mostly send  
All send  
Mostly send specifies that most of the memory is set to send fax jobs.  
All send specifies that all the memory is set to send fax jobs.  
All receive specifies that all the memory is set to receive fax jobs.  
Mostly receive specifies that most of the memory is set to receive fax jobs.  
Cancel Faxes  
Allow  
Specify whether the printer cancels fax jobs.  
Note: Allow is the factory default setting.  
Don't Allow  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
120  
Use  
To  
Caller ID  
Off  
Specify the type of caller ID being used.  
Primary  
Alternate  
Fax Number Masking  
Off  
Specify the direction from where digits are masked in an outgoing fax number.  
Notes:  
From left  
From right  
Off is the factory default setting.  
The “Digits to mask” setting determines the number of characters masked.  
Digits to Mask  
Specify the number of digits to mask in an outgoing fax number.  
0–58  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Fax Send Settings  
Use  
To  
Resolution  
Specify quality in dots per inch (dpi). A higher resolution gives better print quality, but  
increases the fax transmission time for outgoing faxes.  
Standard  
Fine 200 dpi  
Note: Standard is the factory default setting.  
Super Fine 300 dpi  
Ultra Fine 600 dpi  
Original Size  
A4  
Specify the size of the original document.  
Note: Mixed Sizes is the US factory default setting. A4 is the international factory  
A5  
default setting.  
A6  
JIS B5  
Letter  
Legal  
Executive  
Folio  
Statement  
Oficio (Mexico)  
Universal  
Auto Size Sense  
Mixed Sizes  
Custom Scan Size [x]  
Book Original  
Business Card  
3 x 5 in.  
4 x 6 in.  
Content Type  
Text  
Specify the content of the original document.  
Note: Text is the factory default setting.  
Text/Photo  
Photo  
Graphics  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
121  
Use  
To  
Content Source  
Black/White Laser  
Color Laser  
Inkjet  
Specify how the original document was produced.  
Note: Black/White Laser is the factory default setting.  
Photo/Film  
Magazine  
Newspaper  
Press  
Other  
Darkness  
Lighten or darken the output.  
1–9  
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.  
Dial Prefix  
Enter a dialing prefix, such as 99. A numeric entry field is provided.  
Automatic Redial  
Specify the number of times the printer tries to send the fax to a specified number.  
0–9  
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.  
Redial Frequency  
Specify the number of minutes between redials.  
1–200  
Note: 3 is the factory default setting.  
Behind a PABX  
Enable or disable switchboard blind dialing without a dial tone.  
Yes  
No  
Note: No is the factory default setting.  
Enable ECM  
Enable or disable Error Correction Mode for fax jobs.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
Enable Fax Scans  
Fax files that are scanned at the printer.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Driver to Fax  
Allow the print driver to send fax jobs.  
Yes  
No  
Note: Yes is the factory default setting.  
Allow Save as Shortcut  
Save fax numbers as shortcuts in the printer.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Dial Mode  
Tone  
Specify the dialing sound, either as a tone or a pulse.  
Note: Tone is the factory default setting.  
Pulse  
Max Speed  
2400  
Specify the maximum speed in baud at which faxes are sent.  
Note: 33600 is the factory default setting.  
4800  
9600  
14400  
33600  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
122  
Use  
To  
Background Removal  
Adjust the amount of background visible on a scanned image.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Color Dropout  
Specify which color to drop and to adjust the dropout setting for each color threshold.  
Color Dropout  
Notes:  
None  
None is the factory default setting for Color Dropout.  
Red  
Green  
128 is the factory default setting for each color threshold.  
Blue  
Default Red Threshold  
0–255  
Default Green Threshold  
0–255  
Default Blue Threshold  
0–255  
Contrast  
0–5  
Specify the contrast in the scanned image.  
Note: Best for content is the factory default setting.  
Best for content  
Mirror Image  
Create a mirror image of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Negative Image  
Create a negative image of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Shadow Detail  
Adjust the amount of shadow detail visible.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Adjust ADF Skew  
Correct the slight skew in the scanned image.  
Auto  
Off  
Note: Auto is the factory default setting.  
On  
Scan Edge to Edge  
Specify whether the original document is scanned edgetoedge.  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Off  
On  
Sharpness  
Adjust the sharpness of a fax.  
1–5  
Note: 3 is the factory default setting.  
Enable Color Fax Scans  
Off by default  
On by default  
Never Use  
Enable color faxing.  
Note: Off by default is the factory default setting.  
Always Use  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
123  
Use  
To  
Auto Convert Color Faxes to Mono Convert all outgoing faxes to black and white.  
Faxes  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
On  
Off  
Fax Receive Settings  
Use  
To  
Enable Fax Receive  
Allow the printer to receive fax jobs.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Enable Caller ID  
Allow the printer to show caller ID.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Rings to Answer  
Specify the number of rings before answering an incoming fax job.  
1–25  
Note: 3 is the factory default setting.  
Auto Answer  
Set the printer to receive faxes automatically.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Manual Answer Code  
Enter a code on the telephone number pad to begin receiving a fax.  
0–9  
Notes:  
*9* is the factory default setting.  
This menu item is used when the printer shares a line with a telephone.  
Auto Reduction  
Scale an incoming fax job so that it fits the size of the paper loaded in the designated  
fax source.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Paper Source  
Auto  
Specify the paper source for printing incoming fax jobs.  
Note: Auto is the factory default setting.  
Tray [x]  
MP Feeder  
Sides (Duplex)  
Enable twosided printing for incoming fax jobs.  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Off  
On  
Separator Sheets  
Off  
Enable the printer to include separator sheets for incoming fax jobs.  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Before Job  
After Job  
Separator Sheet Source  
Tray [x]  
Specify the paper source for the separator sheet.  
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.  
MP Feeder  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
124  
Use  
To  
Fax Footer  
Print the transmission information at the bottom of each page from a received fax.  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Max Speed  
2400  
Specify the maximum speed in baud at which faxes are received.  
Note: 33600 is the factory default setting.  
4800  
9600  
14400  
33600  
Fax Forwarding  
Print  
Enable forwarding of received faxes to another recipient.  
Note: Print is the factory default setting.  
Print and Forward  
Forward  
Forward to  
Fax  
Specify the type of recipient to which faxes are forwarded.  
Notes:  
Email  
FTP  
LDSS  
Fax is the factory default setting.  
This menu is available only from the printer Embedded Web Server.  
Forward to Shortcut  
Enter the shortcut number which matches the recipient type (Fax, E-mail, FTP, or  
LDSS).  
Note: You can enter up to 16 characters.  
Block No Name Fax  
Enable blocking of incoming faxes sent from devices with no fax ID specified.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Enable Color Fax Receive  
Enable the printer to receive fax in color and print it in grayscale.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Fax Log Settings  
Use  
To  
Transmission Log  
Print log  
Enable printing of a transmission log after each fax job.  
Note: Print log is the factory default setting.  
Do not print log  
Print only for error  
Receive Error Log  
Print Never  
Enable printing of a receive error log following a receive error.  
Note: Print Never is the factory default setting.  
Print on Error  
Auto Print Logs  
Enable automatic printing of fax logs.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
Logs print after every 200 fax jobs.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
125  
Use  
To  
Log Paper Source  
Tray [x]  
Specify the source of the paper used for printing logs.  
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.  
MP Feeder  
Logs Display  
Specify whether printed logs display the dialed number or fax name returned.  
Remote Station Name  
Dialed Number  
Note: Remote Station Name is the factory default setting.  
Enable Job Log  
Enable access to the Fax Job log.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Enable Call Log  
Enable access to the Fax Call log.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Speaker Settings  
Use  
To  
Speaker Mode  
Always Off  
Specify the mode of the speaker.  
Note: On until Connected is the factory default setting. A sound is issued until the  
On until Connected  
Always On  
fax connection is made.  
Speaker Volume  
Control the volume setting.  
High  
Low  
Note: High is the factory default setting.  
Ringer Volume  
Control the fax speaker ringer volume.  
Off  
On  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Answer On  
Use  
To  
All Rings  
Specify ring patterns when the printer is answering calls.  
Single Ring Only  
Note: All Rings is the factory default setting.  
Double Ring Only  
Triple Ring Only  
Single or Double Rings Only  
Single or Triple Rings Only  
Double or Triple Rings Only  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
126  
Email Settings menu  
Use  
To  
Email Server Setup  
Send me a copy  
Never appears  
On by default  
Off by default  
Always On  
Send a copy of the e-mail to the sender.  
Note: “Never appears” is the factory default setting.  
Email Server Setup  
Max Email size  
0–65535 KB  
Specify the maximum e-mail size in kilobytes.  
Note: E-mails larger than the specified size are not sent.  
Format  
Specify the format of the scanned file.  
PDF (.pdf)  
Secure PDF  
TIFF (.tif)  
JPEG (.jpg)  
XPS (.xps)  
Note: PDF (.pdf) is the factory default setting.  
PDF Version  
1.2–1.7  
Set the version of the PDF file that will be scanned for emailing.  
Note: 1.5 is the factory default setting.  
A–1a  
Content Type  
Text  
Specify the content of the original document.  
Note: Text/Photo is the factory default setting.  
Graphics  
Text/Photo  
Photo  
Content Source  
Black/White Laser  
Color Laser  
Inkjet  
Specify how the original document was produced.  
Note: Black/White Laser is the factory default setting.  
Photo/Film  
Magazine  
Newspaper  
Press  
Other  
Resolution  
75 dpi  
Specify the resolution of the scan in dots per inch.  
Note: 150 dpi is the factory default setting.  
150 dpi  
200 dpi  
300 dpi  
400 dpi  
600 dpi  
Darkness  
Lighten or darken the output.  
1–9  
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
127  
Use  
To  
Orientation  
Portrait  
Specify the orientation of the scanned image.  
Note: Portrait is the factory default setting.  
Landscape  
Original Size  
Letter  
Specify the paper size of the document being scanned.  
Notes:  
Legal  
Executive  
Folio  
A4 is the international factory default setting.  
Letter is the U.S. factory default setting.  
Statement  
Oficio (Mexico)  
Universal  
Auto Size Sense  
Mixed Sizes  
A4  
A5  
A6  
JIS B5  
Custom Scan Size [x]  
Book Original  
Business Card  
3 x 5 in.  
4 x 6 in.  
Sides (Duplex)  
Off  
Specify the page orientation of text and graphics.  
Notes:  
Long edge  
Short edge  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Long edge assumes binding along the long edge of the page (left edge for  
portrait and top edge for landscape).  
Short edge assumes binding along the short edge of the page (top edge for  
portrait and left edge for landscape).  
JPEG Quality  
Best for content  
5–90  
Set the quality of a JPEG photo image in relation to file size and quality of the image.  
Notes:  
“Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
5 reduces the file size and quality of the image.  
90 provides the best image quality, but the file size is very large.  
This menu setting applies to all scan functions.  
Text Default  
Set the quality of a text image in relation to file size and quality of the image.  
5–90  
Note: 75 is the factory default setting.  
Text/Photo Default  
Set the quality of a text or photo image in relation to file size and the quality of the  
image.  
5–90  
Note: 75 is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
128  
Use  
To  
Photo Default  
Set the quality of a photo image in relation to file size and the quality of the image.  
5–90  
Note: 50 is the factory default setting.  
Email images sent as  
Attachment  
Specify how the images are sent.  
Note: Attachment is the factory default setting.  
Web Link  
Use Multipage Tiff  
Provide a choice between single-page TIFF files and multiplepage TIFF files. For a  
multiple-page scantoe-mail job, either one TIFF file is created containing all the  
pages, or multiple TIFF files are created with one file for each page of the job.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
This menu applies to all scan functions.  
Transmission Log  
Print log  
Specify whether or not the transmission log prints.  
Note: Print log is the factory default setting.  
Do not print log  
Print only for error  
Log Paper Source  
Tray [x]  
Specify the paper source for printing e-mail logs.  
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.  
MP Feeder  
Allow Save as Shortcut  
Save e-mail addresses as shortcuts.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
When set to Off, the Save as Shortcut button does not appear on the e-mail  
Destination screen.  
Background Removal  
Adjust the amount of background visible on a scanned image.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Color Dropout  
Specify which color to drop and to adjust the dropout setting for each color threshold.  
Color Dropout  
Notes:  
None  
None is the factory default setting for Color Dropout.  
Red  
Green  
128 is the factory default setting for each color threshold.  
Blue  
Default Red Threshold  
0–255  
Default Green Threshold  
0–255  
Default Blue Threshold  
0–255  
Contrast  
0–5  
Specify the contrast of the output.  
Note: “Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
Best for content  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
129  
Use  
To  
Mirror Image  
Create a mirror image of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Negative Image  
Create a negative image of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Shadow Detail  
Adjust the amount of shadow detail visible on a scanned image.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Adjust ADF Skew  
Correct slight skew in the scanned image.  
Auto  
Off  
Note: Auto is the factory default setting.  
On  
Scan edge to edge  
Specify whether the original document is scanned edge-to-edge.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Sharpness  
Adjust the amount of sharpness on a scanned image.  
1–5  
Note: 3 is the factory default setting.  
Use cc:/bcc:  
Enable the use of the cc: and bcc: fields.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
FTP Settings menu  
Use  
To  
Format  
Specify the format of the file for FTP sending.  
PDF (.pdf)  
Secure PDF (.pdf)  
TIFF (.tif)  
Note: PDF (.pdf) is the factory default setting.  
JPEG (.jpg)  
XPS (.xps)  
PDF Version  
1.2–1.7  
Set the version level of the PDF file for FTP sending.  
Note: 1.5 is the factory default setting.  
A–1a  
Content Type  
Text  
Specify the content of the original document.  
Note: Text/Photo is the factory default setting.  
Graphics  
Text/Photo  
Photo  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
130  
Use  
To  
Content Source  
Black/White Laser  
Color Laser  
Inkjet  
Specify how the original document was produced.  
Note: Black/White Laser is the factory default setting.  
Photo/Film  
Magazine  
Newspaper  
Press  
Other  
Resolution  
75 dpi  
Specify the quality of the scan in dots per inch (dpi).  
Note: 150 dpi is the factory default setting.  
150 dpi  
200 dpi  
300 dpi  
400 dpi  
600 dpi  
Darkness  
Lighten or darken the output.  
1–9  
Note: 5 is the factory default setting.  
Orientation  
Portrait  
Specify the orientation of the scanned image.  
Note: Portrait is the factory default setting.  
Landscape  
Original Size  
Letter  
Specify the paper size of the original document.  
Notes:  
Legal  
Executive  
Folio  
Letter is the U.S. factory default setting.  
A4 is the international factory default setting.  
Statement  
Oficio (Mexico)  
Universal  
Auto Size Sense  
Mixed Sizes  
A4  
A5  
A6  
JIS B5  
Custom Scan Size [x]  
Book Original  
Business Card  
3 x 5 in.  
4 x 6 in.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
131  
Use  
To  
Sides (Duplex)  
Off  
Specify the page orientation of text and graphics.  
Notes:  
Long Edge  
Short Edge  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Long Edge sets binding along the long edge of the page (left edge for portrait  
and top edge for landscape).  
Short Edge sets binding along the short edge of the page (top edge for portrait  
and left edge for landscape).  
JPEG Quality  
Best for content  
5–90  
Set the quality of a JPEG photo image in relation to the file size and quality of the  
image.  
Notes:  
“Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
5 reduces the image quality and the file size.  
90 produces the best image quality at an increased file size.  
This menu setting applies to all scan functions.  
Text Default  
Set the quality of the text in relation to the file size and quality of the image.  
5–90  
Note: 75 is the factory default setting.  
Text/Photo Default  
Set the quality of a text or photo image in relation to the file size and quality of the  
image.  
5–90  
Note: 75 is the factory default setting.  
Photo Default  
Set the quality of a photo image in relation to the file size and quality of the image.  
5–90  
Note: 50 is the factory default setting.  
Use MultiPage TIFF  
Choose between single-page TIFF files and multiplepage TIFF files.  
On  
Off  
For a multiple-page scantoFTP job, either one TIFF file is created containing all the  
pages, or multiple TIFF files are created with one file for each page of the job.  
Notes:  
On is the factory default setting.  
This menu setting applies to all scan functions.  
Transmission Log  
Print log  
Specify whether or not the transmission log prints.  
Note: “Print log” is the factory default setting.  
Do not print log  
Print only for error  
Log Paper Source  
Tray [x]  
Specify a paper source when printing FTP logs.  
Note: Tray 1 is the factory default setting.  
MP Feeder  
FTP Bit Depth  
1 bit  
Enable the Text/Photo mode to have smaller file sizes by using 1bit images.  
Note: 8 bit is the factory default setting.  
8 bit  
Allow Save as Shortcut  
Enable shortcut creation for FTP addresses.  
On  
Off  
Note: On is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
132  
Use  
To  
Background Removal  
Adjust the amount of background visible on a copy.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Color Dropout  
Specify whichcolor to drop and to adjust thedropout setting for each color threshold.  
Color Dropout  
Notes:  
None  
None is the factory default setting for Color Dropout.  
Red  
Green  
128 is the factory default setting for each color threshold.  
Blue  
Default Red Threshold  
0–255  
Default Green Threshold  
0–255  
Default Blue Threshold  
0–255  
Contrast  
0–5  
Specify the contrast of the output.  
Note: “Best for content” is the factory default setting.  
Best for content  
Mirror Image  
Create a mirror image of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Negative Image  
Create a negative image of the original document.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Shadow Detail  
Adjust the amount of shadow detail visible on a scanned image.  
4 to 4  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Adjust ADF Skew  
Correct slight skew in the scanned image.  
Auto  
Off  
Note: Auto is the factory default setting.  
On  
Scan edge to edge  
Specify whether the original document is scanned edge-to-edge.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Sharpness  
Adjust the amount of sharpness of a scanned image  
1–5  
Note: 3 is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
133  
Print Settings  
Setup menu  
Use  
To  
Printer Language  
PCL Emulation  
PS Emulation  
Set the default printer language.  
Notes:  
PCL Emulation is the factory default printer language.  
Setting a printer language as the default does not prevent a  
software program from sending print jobs that use another  
printer language.  
Print Area  
Normal  
Set the logical and physical printable area.  
Note: Normal is the factory default setting. When attempting to  
print data in the nonprintable area defined by the Normal  
setting, the printer clips the image at the boundary.  
Whole Page  
Resource Save  
Specify how the printer handles temporary downloads, such as  
fonts and macros stored in the RAM, when the printer receives a  
job that requires more memory than is available.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting. This sets the printer to  
retain the downloads only until memory is needed.  
Downloads are deleted in order to process print jobs.  
On retains the downloads during language changes and  
printer resets. If the printer runs out of memory, then  
Memory Full [38]appears, and downloads are not  
deleted.  
Finishing menu  
Use  
To  
Sides (Duplex)  
1 sided  
Specify whether twosided (duplex) printing is set as the user default setting for all  
print jobs.  
2 sided  
Notes:  
“1 sided” is the factory default setting.  
You can set twosided printing from the software program.  
For Windows users:  
Click File > Print, and then click Properties, Preferences, Options, or Setup.  
For Macintosh users:  
Choose File > Print, and then adjust the settings from the print dialog and  
popup menus.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
134  
Use  
To  
Duplex Binding  
Long Edge  
Define the way twosided pages are bound and printed.  
Notes:  
Short Edge  
Long Edge is the factory default setting. This assumes binding along the long  
edge of the page (left edge for portrait and top edge for landscape).  
Short Edge assumes binding along the short edge of the page (top edge for  
portrait and left edge for landscape).  
Copies  
Specify the default number of copies for each print job.  
1–999  
Note: 1 is the factory default setting.  
Blank Pages  
Do Not Print  
Print  
Specify whether or not blank pages are inserted in a print job.  
Note: Do Not Print is the factory default setting.  
Collate  
Stack the pages of a print job in sequence when printing multiple copies.  
(1,1,1) (2,2,2)  
(1,2,3) (1,2,3)  
Note: “(1,2,3) (1,2,3)” is the factory default setting.  
Separator Sheets  
Off  
Specify whether or not blank separator sheets are inserted.  
Notes:  
Between Copies  
Between Jobs  
Between Pages  
Off is the factory default setting.  
Between Copies inserts a blank sheet between each copy of a print job if  
Collate is set to “(1,2,3) (1,2,3).” If Collate is set to “(1,1,1) (2,2,2),” then a  
blank page is inserted between each set of printed pages, such as after all  
page 1's and after all page 2's.  
Between Jobs inserts a blank sheet between print jobs.  
Between Pages inserts a blank sheet between each page of a print job. This  
setting is useful when printing transparencies or when inserting blank pages in  
a document.  
Separator Source  
Tray [x]  
Specify the paper source for separator sheet.  
Notes:  
MP Feeder  
Tray 1 (standard tray) is the factory default setting.  
From the Paper menu, set Configure MP to “Cassette” for MP Feeder to  
appear as a menu setting.  
Paper Saver  
Off  
Print multiple pages on one sheet of paper.  
Notes:  
2Up  
Off is the factory default setting.  
3Up  
When the number of pages per sheet is selected, each page is scaled so that  
the number of pages you want can be displayed on the sheet.  
4Up  
6Up  
9Up  
12Up  
16Up  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
135  
Use  
To  
Paper Saver Ordering  
Horizontal  
Specify theorder in which pages are printed on a singlesheet whenusing Paper Saver.  
Notes:  
Reverse Horizontal  
Reverse Vertical  
Vertical  
Horizontal is the factory default setting.  
Positioning depends on the number of pages and whether they are in portrait  
or landscape orientation.  
Paper Saver Orientation  
Auto  
Specify the orientation in which pages are printed on a single sheet.  
Note: Auto is the factory default setting. The printer chooses between portrait and  
Landscape  
landscape.  
Portrait  
Paper Saver Border  
Print a border when using Paper Saver.  
None  
Solid  
Note: None is the factory default setting.  
Quality menu  
Use  
To  
Print Resolution  
300 dpi  
Specify the printed output resolution in dots per inch.  
Note: 600 dpi is the factory default setting.  
600 dpi  
1200 dpi  
1200 Image Q  
2400 Image Q  
Pixel Boost  
Off  
Enablemore pixelsto print in clusters for clarity, in order to enhance images horizontally  
or vertically, or to enhance fonts.  
Fonts  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Horizontally  
Vertically  
Both directions  
Isolated  
Toner Darkness  
Lighten or darken the printed output.  
1–10  
Notes:  
8 is the factory default setting.  
Selecting a smaller number can help conserve toner.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
136  
Use  
To  
Enhance Fine Lines  
Enable a print mode preferable for files such as architectural drawings, maps, electrical  
circuit diagrams, and flow charts.  
On  
Off  
Notes:  
Off is the factory default setting.  
You can set this option from the printer software. For Windows users, click File >  
Print, and then click Properties, Preferences, Options, or Setup. For Macintosh  
users, choose File > Print, and then adjust the settings from the Print dialog and  
popup menus.  
To set this option using the Embedded Web Server, type the network printer IP  
address in the Web browser address field.  
Gray Correction  
Automatically adjust the contrast enhancement applied to images.  
Auto  
Off  
Note: Auto is the factory default setting.  
Brightness  
Adjust the printed output either by lightening or darkening it. You can conserve toner  
by lightening the output.  
6 to 6  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Contrast  
Adjust the contrast of printed objects.  
0–5  
Note: 0 is the factory default setting.  
Utilities menu  
Use  
To  
Format Flash  
Format the flash memory.  
Yes  
No  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not turn off the printer while the flash memory is  
being formatted.  
Notes:  
Yes deletes all data stored in flash memory.  
No cancels the format request.  
Flash memory refers to the memory added by installing a flash memory card in  
the printer.  
The flash memory option card must not be read/writeor writeprotected.  
This menu item appears only when a nondefective flash memory card is  
installed.  
Activate Hex Trace  
Assist in isolating the source of a print job problem.  
Notes:  
When activated, all data sent to the printer is printed in hexadecimal and  
character representation, and control codes are not executed.  
To exit or deactivate Hex Trace, turn off or reset the printer.  
Coverage Estimator  
Provide an estimate of the percentage coverage of toner on a page. The estimate is  
printed on a separate page at the end of each print job.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
137  
XPS menu  
Use  
To  
Print Error Pages  
Print a page containing information on errors, including XML markup errors.  
Off  
On  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
PDF menu  
Use  
To  
Scale to Fit  
Scale page content to fit the selected paper size.  
Yes  
No  
Note: No is the factory default setting.  
Annotations  
Do Not Print  
Print  
Print annotations in a PDF.  
Note: Do Not Print is the factory default setting.  
PCL Emul menu  
Use  
To  
Font Source  
Resident  
Download  
All  
Specify the set of fonts used in the Font Name menu.  
Notes:  
“Resident” is the factory default setting. It shows the factory default set  
of fonts downloaded in the RAM.  
“Download” shows all the fonts downloaded in the RAM.  
“All” shows all fonts available to any option.  
Font Name  
Identify a specific font and where it is stored.  
Courier 10  
Note: Courier 10 is the factory default setting.  
Symbol Set  
10U PC8  
Specify the symbol set for each font name.  
Notes:  
12U PC850  
10U PC8 is the U.S. factory default setting. 12U PC850 is the  
international factory default setting.  
A symbol set is a set of alphabetical and numeric characters, punctuation,  
and special symbols. Symbol sets support the different languages or  
specific programs, such as math symbols for scientific text. Only the  
supported symbol sets are shown.  
PCL Emulation Settings  
Point Size  
Change the point size for scalable typographic fonts.  
Notes:  
1.00–1008.00  
12 is the factory default setting.  
Point size refers to the height of the characters in the font. One point  
equals approximately 0.014 of an inch. This can be increased or decreased  
in 0.25point increments.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Understanding the printer menus  
138  
Use  
To  
PCL Emulation Settings  
Pitch  
Specify the font pitch for scalable monospaced fonts.  
Notes:  
0.08–100.00  
10 is the factory default setting.  
Pitch refers to the number of fixedspace characters per inch (cpi). This  
can be increased or decreased in 0.01cpi increments.  
For nonscalable monospaced fonts, the pitch appears on the display but  
cannot be changed.  
PCL Emulation Settings  
Orientation  
Specify the orientation of text and graphics on a page.  
Notes:  
Portrait  
Landscape  
Portrait is the factory default setting. It prints text and graphics parallel to  
the short edge of the page.  
Landscape prints text and graphics parallel to the long edge of the page.  
Specify the number of lines that print on each page.  
Notes:  
PCL Emulation Settings  
Lines per Page  
1–255  
60 is the U.S. factory default setting. 64 is the international default  
setting.  
The printer sets the amount of space between each line based on the  
Lines per Page, Paper Size, and Orientation settings. Select the paper size  
and orientation before setting Lines per Page.  
PCL Emulation Settings  
A4 Width  
Set the printer to print on A4size paper.  
Notes:  
198 mm  
203 mm  
198 mm is the factory default setting.  
The 203mm setting sets the width of the page to allow the printing of  
eighty 10pitch characters.  
PCL Emulation Settings  
Specify whether the printer automatically performs a carriage return (CR) after  
a line feed (LF) control command.  
Auto CR after LF  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
PCL Emulation Settings  
Specify whether the printer automatically performs a line feed (LF) after a  
carriage return (CR) control command.  
Auto LF after CR  
On  
Off  
Note: Off is the factory default setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
139  
Use  
To  
Tray Renumber  
Configure the printer to work with printer software or programs that use  
different source assignments for trays and feeders.  
Assign Multipurpose Feeder  
Off  
Notes:  
None  
0–199  
Assign Tray [x]  
“Off” is the factory default setting.  
“None” ignores the Select Paper Feed command. This option appears only  
when it is selected by the PCL 5e interpreter.  
Off  
None  
“0–199” allows a custom setting to be assigned.  
0–199  
Assign Manual Paper  
Off  
None  
0–199  
Assign Manual Envelope  
Off  
None  
0–199  
Tray Renumber  
View Factory Defaults  
MPF Default = 8  
T1 Default = 1  
Show the factory default setting assigned to each tray or feeder.  
T2 Default = 4  
T3 Default = 5  
T4 Default = 20  
T5 Default = 21  
Env Default = 6  
MPaper Default = 2  
MEnv Default = 3  
Tray Renumber  
Restore all tray and feeder assignments to the factory default settings.  
Restore Defaults  
Yes  
No  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Understanding the printer menus  
140  
HTML menu  
Use  
To  
Font Name  
Albertus MT  
Joanna MT  
Set the default font for HTML documents.  
Letter Gothic  
Lubalin Graph  
Marigold  
MonaLisa Recut  
Monaco  
New CenturySbk  
New York  
Optima  
Note: The Times font is used in HTML documents that do not  
specify a font.  
Antique Olive  
Apple Chancery  
Arial MT  
Avant Garde  
Bodoni  
Bookman  
Chicago  
Clarendon  
Cooper Black  
Copperplate  
Coronet  
Oxford  
Palatino  
StempelGaramond  
Taffy  
Courier  
Times  
Eurostile  
Garamond  
Geneva  
Gill Sans  
Goudy  
TimesNewRoman  
Univers  
Zapf Chancery  
NewSansMTCS  
NewSansMTCT  
New SansMTJA  
NewSansMTKO  
Helvetica  
Hoefler Text  
Intl CG Times  
Intl Courier  
Intl Univers  
Use  
Font Size  
1–255 pt  
To  
Set the default font size for HTML documents.  
Notes:  
12 pt is the factory default setting.  
Font size can be increased in 1point increments.  
Scale the default font for HTML documents.  
Notes:  
Scale  
1–400%  
100% is the factory default setting.  
Scaling can be increased in 1% increments.  
Orientation  
Portrait  
Set the page orientation for HTML documents.  
Note: Portrait is the factory default setting.  
Landscape  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding the printer menus  
141  
Use  
To  
Margin Size  
Set the page margin for HTML documents.  
8–255 mm  
Notes:  
19 mm is the factory default setting.  
Margin size can be increased in 1mm increments.  
Backgrounds  
Do Not Print  
Print  
Specify whether to print backgrounds on HTML documents.  
Note: Print is the factory default setting.  
Image menu  
Use  
To  
Select the optimal paper size, scaling, and orientation.  
Auto Fit  
On  
Note: On is the factory default setting. It overrides scaling and orientation settings  
Off  
for some images.  
Invert  
On  
Invert bitonal monochrome images.  
Notes:  
Off  
Off is the factory default setting.  
This setting does not apply to GIF or JPEG images.  
Scaling  
Scale the image to fit the selected paper size.  
Anchor Top Left  
Best Fit  
Anchor Center  
Fit Height/Width  
Fit Height  
Notes:  
Best Fit is the factory default setting.  
When Auto Fit is set to On, Scaling is automatically set to Best Fit.  
Fit Width  
Orientation  
Portrait  
Set the image orientation.  
Note: Portrait is the factory default setting.  
Landscape  
Reverse Portrait  
Reverse Landscape  
Help menu  
The Help menu consists of a series of Help pages that are stored in the multifunction printer (MFP) as PDF files. They  
contain information about using the printer and performing various tasks, including copying, scanning, and faxing.  
English, French, German, and Spanish translations are stored in the printer. Other translations are available at  
Menu item  
Description  
Print All Guides  
Copy Guide  
Prints all the guides  
Provides information about making copies and changing settings  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding the printer menus  
142  
Menu item  
Description  
Email Guide  
Provides information about sending emails using addresses, shortcut numbers, or  
the address book, and about changing settings  
Fax Guide  
FTP Guide  
Provides information about sending faxes using fax numbers, shortcut numbers,  
or the address book, and about changing settings  
Provides information about scanning documents directly to an FTP server using an  
FTP address, shortcut numbers, or the address book, and about changing settings  
Print Defects Guide  
Information Guide  
Supplies Guide  
Provides help in resolving repeating defects in copies or prints  
Provides help in locating additional information  
Provides part numbers for ordering supplies  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Saving money and the environment  
143  
Saving money and the environment  
Lexmark is committed to environmental sustainability and is continually improving its printers to reduce their impact  
on the environment. We design with the environment in mind, engineer our packaging to reduce materials, and provide  
collection and recycling programs. For more information, see:  
The Notices chapter  
The Environmental Sustainability section of the Lexmark Web site at www.lexmark.com/environment  
The Lexmark recycling program at www.lexmark.com/recycle  
By selecting certain printer settings or tasks, you may be able to reduce your printer's impact even further. This chapter  
outlines the settings and tasks that may yield a greater environmental benefit.  
Saving paper and toner  
Studies show that as much as 80% of the carbon footprint of a printer is related to paper usage. You can significantly  
reduce your carbon footprint by using recycled paper and the following printing suggestions, such as printing on both  
sides of the paper and printing multiple pages on one side of a single sheet of paper.  
For information on how you can quickly save paper and energy using one printer setting, see “Using Ecomode” on  
Using recycled paper  
As an environmentally conscious company, Lexmark supports the use of recycled office paper produced specifically for  
use in laser printers. For more information on recycled papers that work well with your printer, see “Using recycled  
Conserving supplies  
Use both sides of the paper  
If your printer model supports twosided printing, then you can control whether print appears on one or two sides of  
the paper.  
Notes:  
Two-sided printing is the default setting in the print driver.  
For a complete list of supported products and countries, go to http://support.lexmark.com.  
Place multiple pages on one sheet of paper  
You can print up to 16 consecutive pages of a multiplepage document onto one side of a single sheet of paper by  
setting multiple page printing (NUp) for the print job.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Saving money and the environment  
144  
Check your first draft for accuracy  
Before printing or making multiple copies of a document:  
Use the preview feature to see how the document looks like before you print it.  
Print one copy of the document to check its content and format for accuracy.  
Avoid paper jams  
Correctly set the paper type and size to avoid paper jams. For more information, see “Avoiding jams” on page 164.  
Saving energy  
Using Ecomode  
Use EcoMode to quickly select one or more ways to reduce your printer's environmental impact.  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings > Settings >  
> General Settings >  
> EcoMode >  
> select the setting you want  
Use  
To  
Off  
Use the factory default settings for all settings associated with EcoMode. This setting supports the  
performance specifications for your printer.  
Energy  
Reduce energy use, especially when the printer is idle.  
Printer engine motors do not start until a job is ready to print. You may notice a short delay before  
the first page is printed.  
The printer enters Sleep mode after one minute of inactivity.  
Energy/Paper Use all the settings associated with Energy and Paper modes.  
Plain Paper  
Enable the automatic twosided (duplex) feature.  
Turn off print log features.  
2 Press  
.
Reducing printer noise  
Enable Quiet mode to reduce the printer noise.  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings >  
> Settings >  
> General Settings >  
> Quiet Mode >  
2 Select a setting.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Saving money and the environment  
145  
Use  
To  
On  
Reduce printer noise.  
Notes:  
Print jobs process at a reduced speed.  
Printer engine motors do not start until a document  
is ready to print. There is a short delay before the  
first page is printed.  
The alarm control and cartridge alarm sounds are  
turned off.  
The printer ignores the Advance Start command.  
Off  
Use factory default settings.  
Note: This setting supports the performance  
specifications of the printer.  
3 Press  
.
Adjusting Sleep mode  
To save energy, decrease the number of minutes before the printer enters Sleep mode. Select from 1 to 120. The factory  
default setting is 30 minutes.  
Note: The printer still accepts print jobs when in Sleep mode.  
Using the Embedded Web Server  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Navigate to:  
Settings > General Settings > Timeouts  
3 In the Sleep Mode field, enter the number of minutes you want the printer to wait before it enters Sleep mode.  
4 Click Submit.  
Using the printer control panel  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings >  
> Settings >  
> General Settings >  
> Timeouts >  
> Sleep Mode >  
2 In the Sleep Mode field, select the number of minutes you want the printer to wait before it enters Sleep mode.  
3 Press  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Saving money and the environment  
146  
Using Hibernate mode  
Hibernate is an ultralowpower saving mode.  
Notes:  
Three days is the default amount of time before the printer enters Hibernate mode.  
Make sure to wake the printer from Hibernate mode before sending a print job. A hard reset or a long press of  
the Sleep button wakes the printer from Hibernate mode.  
If the printer is in Hibernate mode, then the Embedded Web Server is disabled.  
1 From the control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings >  
2 Select Press Sleep Button or Press and Hold Sleep Button, and then press  
3 Press Hibernate >  
> Settings >  
> General Settings >  
.
.
Adjusting the brightness of the printer display  
To save energy, or if you have trouble reading the display, adjust its brightness settings.  
Using the Embedded Web Server  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > General Settings.  
3 In the Screen Brightness field, enter the brightness percentage you want for the display.  
4 Click Submit.  
Using Schedule Power Modes  
Schedule Power Modes lets the user schedule when the printer goes into a reduced power state or into the Ready  
state.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > General Settings > Schedule Power Modes.  
3 From the Action menu, select the power mode.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Saving money and the environment  
147  
4 From the Time menu, select the time.  
5 From the Day(s) menu, select the day or days.  
6 Click Add.  
Recycling  
Lexmark provides collection programs and environmentally progressive approaches to recycling. For more information,  
see:  
The Notices chapter  
The Environmental Sustainability section of the Lexmark Web site at www.lexmark.com/environment  
The Lexmark recycling program at www.lexmark.com/recycle  
Recycling Lexmark products  
To return Lexmark products for recycling:  
2 Find the product type you want to recycle, and then select your country or region from the list.  
3 Follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
Note: Printer supplies and hardware not listed in the Lexmark collection program may be recycled through your local  
recycling center. Contact your local recycling center to determine the items they accept.  
Recycling Lexmark packaging  
Lexmark continually strives tominimize packaging. Less packaging helps to ensure that Lexmark printers are transported  
in the most efficient and environmentally sensitive manner and that there is less packaging to dispose of. These  
efficiencies result in fewer greenhouse emissions, energy savings, and natural resource savings.  
Lexmark cartons are 100% recyclable where corrugated recycling facilities exist. Facilities may not exist in your area.  
The foam used in Lexmark packaging is recyclable where foam recycling facilities exist. Facilities may not exist in your  
area.  
When you return a cartridge to Lexmark, you can reuse the box that the cartridge came in. Lexmark will recycle the  
box.  
Returning Lexmark cartridges for reuse or recycling  
Lexmark Cartridge Collection Program diverts millions of Lexmark cartridges from landfills annually by making it both  
easy and free for Lexmark customers to return used cartridges to Lexmark for reuse or recycling. One hundred percent  
of the empty cartridges returned to Lexmark are either reused or demanufactured for recycling. Boxes used to return  
the cartridges are also recycled.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Saving money and the environment  
148  
To return Lexmark cartridges for reuse or recycling, follow the instructions that came with your printer or cartridge and  
use the prepaid shipping label. You can also do the following:  
2 From the Toner Cartridges section, select your country or region.  
3 Follow the instructions on the computer screen.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Securing the printer  
149  
Securing the printer  
Statement of Volatility  
Your printer contains various types of memory that can store device and network settings, and user data.  
Type of memory  
Description  
Volatile memory  
Your printer uses standard random access memory (RAM) to  
temporarily buffer user data during simple print jobs.  
Non-volatile memory  
Your printer may use two forms of non-volatile memory:  
EEPROM and NAND (flash memory). Both types are used to  
store operating system, device settings, and network  
information.  
Erase the content of any installed printer memory in the following circumstances:  
The printer is being decommissioned.  
The printer is being moved to a different department or location.  
The printer is being serviced by someone from outside your organization.  
The printer is being removed from your premises for service.  
The printer is being sold to another organization.  
Erasing volatile memory  
The volatile memory (RAM) installed in your printer requires a power source to retain information. To erase the buffered  
data, simply turn off the printer.  
Erasing nonvolatile memory  
Individual settings, device and network settings, security settings, and embedded solutions—Erase information  
and settings by selecting Wipe All Settings in the Configuration menu.  
Fax data—Erase fax settings and data by selecting Wipe All Settings in the Configuration menu.  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Hold down 2 and 6 while turning the printer on. Release the buttons only when the screen with the progress bar  
appears.  
The printer performs a power-on sequence, and then the Configuration menu appears. When the printer is fully  
powered up, the printer displays a list of functions.  
3 Press the up or down arrow button until Wipe All Settingsappears.  
The printer will restart several times during this process.  
Note: Wipe All Settings securely removes device settings, solutions, jobs, faxes, and passwords from the printer  
memory.  
4 Navigate to:  
Back > Exit Config Menu  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Securing the printer  
150  
The printer will perform a poweron reset, and then return to normal operating mode.  
Finding printer security information  
In high-security environments, it may be necessary to take additional steps to make sure that confidential data stored  
in the printer cannot be accessed by unauthorized persons. For more information, visit the  
You can also see the Embedded Web Server — Security: Administrator’s Guide for additional information:  
1 Go to www.lexmark.com, and then navigate to Support & Downloads > select your printer.  
2 Click the Manuals tab, and then select Embedded Web Server — Security: Administrator’s Guide.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintaining the printer  
151  
Maintaining the printer  
Cleaning printer parts  
Cleaning the printer  
Note: You may need to perform this task after every few months.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Damage to the printer caused by improper handling is not covered by the printer  
warranty.  
1 Make sure that the printer is turned off and unplugged from the electrical outlet.  
CAUTION—SHOCK HAZARD: To avoid the risk of electrical shock when cleaning the exterior of the printer,  
unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet and disconnect all cables from the printer before  
proceeding.  
2 Remove paper from the standard bin and multipurpose feeder.  
3 Remove any dust, lint, and pieces of paper around the printer using a soft brush or vacuum.  
4 Dampen a clean, lint-free cloth with water, and use it to wipe the outside of the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not use household cleaners or detergents to prevent damage to the exterior  
of the printer.  
5 Make sure all areas of the printer are dry before sending a new print job.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Maintaining the printer  
152  
Cleaning the scanner glass  
Clean the scanner glass if you encounter print quality problems, such as streaks on copied or scanned images.  
1 Slightly dampen a soft, lint-free cloth or paper towel with water.  
2 Open the scanner cover.  
3 Clean all the areas shown, and then let them dry.  
1 White underside of the scanner cover  
2 Scanner glass  
3 ADF glass  
4 White underside of the ADF cover  
4 Close the scanner cover.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintaining the printer  
153  
Checking the status of parts and supplies  
A message appears on the display when a replacement supply item is needed or when maintenance is required.  
Checking the status of parts and supplies on the printer control panel  
From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Status/Supplies >  
> View Supplies >  
Checking the status of parts and supplies from the Embedded Web Server  
Note: Make sure the computer and printer are connected to the same network.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Device Status > More Details.  
Estimated number of remaining pages  
The estimated number of remaining pages is based on the recent printing history of the printer. Its accuracy may  
vary significantly and is dependent on many factors, such as actual document content, print quality settings, and  
other printer settings.  
The accuracy of the estimated number of remaining pages may decrease when the actual printing consumption is  
differentfromthehistorical printingconsumption. Considerthe variablelevel of accuracy beforepurchasing or replacing  
supplies based on the estimate. Until an adequate print history is obtained on the printer, initial estimates assume  
future supplies consumption based on the International Organization for Standardization* test methods and page  
content.  
* Average continuous black declared cartridge yield in accordance with ISO/IEC 19752.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Maintaining the printer  
154  
Ordering supplies  
To order parts and supplies in the U.S., contact Lexmark at 1-800-539-6275 for information about Lexmark authorized  
supplies dealers in your area. In other countries or regions, go to www.lexmark.com or contact the place where you  
purchased the printer.  
The Lexmark Return Program lets you purchase Lexmark supplies at a discounted price in exchange for your agreement  
to use the supplies only once and return them only to Lexmark for remanufacturing or recycling.  
Using genuine Lexmark parts and supplies  
Your Lexmark printer is designed to function best with genuine Lexmark supplies and parts. Use of third-party supplies  
or parts may affect the performance, reliability, or life of the printer and its imaging components. Use of third-party  
supplies or parts can affect warranty coverage. Damage caused by the use of third-party supplies or parts is not covered  
by the warranty. All life indicators are designed to function with Lexmark supplies and parts, and may deliver  
unpredictable results if third-party supplies or parts are used. Imaging component usage beyond the intended life may  
damage your Lexmark printer or its associated components.  
Ordering a toner cartridge  
Notes:  
The estimated cartridge yield is based on approximately 5% coverage per page.  
Extremely low print coverage for extended periods of time may negatively affect actual yield.  
Part name  
Part number  
Toner Cartridge  
24B6213  
Ordering an imaging unit  
Extremely low print coverage for extended periods of time may cause imaging unit parts to fail prior to exhaustion of  
toner from toner cartridge.  
For more information on replacing the imaging unit, see the instruction sheet that came with the supply.  
Part name  
Part number  
Imaging unit  
24B6040  
Ordering a maintenance kit  
Notes:  
Using certain types of paper may require more frequent replacement of the maintenance kit.  
The separator roller, fuser, pick rollers, transfer roller, and redrive assembly are all included in the maintenance  
kit and can be individually ordered and replaced if necessary.  
Contact your service representative to replace the maintenance kit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Maintaining the printer  
155  
Maintenance kit  
Part number  
40X9146  
100V maintenance kit*  
110V maintenance kit  
220V maintenance kit  
* This is available only in Japan.  
40X9135  
40X9136  
Ordering an ADF separator pad  
Order an ADF separator pad when the ADF fails to pick paper or picks more than one sheet of paper at a time.  
For information on replacing the ADF separator pad, see the instruction sheet that came with the part.  
Part name  
Part number  
Separator pad  
40X6247  
Storing supplies  
Choose a cool, clean storage area for the printer supplies. Store supplies right side up in their original packing until you  
are ready to use them.  
Do not expose supplies to:  
Direct sunlight  
Temperatures above 35°C (95°F)  
High humidity above 80%  
Salty air  
Corrosive gases  
Heavy dust  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Maintaining the printer  
156  
Replacing supplies  
Replacing the toner cartridge  
1 Press the button on the right side of the printer, and then open the front door.  
2 Pull the toner cartridge out using the handle.  
3 Unpack the toner cartridge, and then remove all packing materials.  
4 Shake the new cartridge to redistribute the toner.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Maintaining the printer  
157  
5 Insert the toner cartridge into the printer by aligning the side rails of the cartridge with the arrows on the side rails  
inside the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes.  
Extended exposure to light may cause print quality problems.  
6 Close the front door.  
Replacing the imaging unit  
1 Press the button on the right side of the printer, and then open the front door.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintaining the printer  
158  
2 Pull the toner cartridge out using the handle.  
3 Lift the green handle, and then pull the imaging unit out of the printer.  
4 Unpack the new imaging unit, and then shake it.  
5 Remove all packing materials from the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes.  
Extended exposure to light may cause print quality problems.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintaining the printer  
159  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the photoconductor drum. Doing so may affect the print quality of  
future print jobs.  
6 Insert the imaging unit into the printer by aligning the arrows on the side rails of the imaging unit with the arrows  
on the side rails inside the printer.  
7 Insert the toner cartridge into the printer by aligning the side rails of the cartridge with the arrows on the side rails  
inside the printer.  
8 Close the front door.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintaining the printer  
160  
Moving the printer  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: The printer weight is greater than 18 kg (40 lb) and requires two or more  
trained personnel to lift it safely.  
Before moving the printer  
CAUTION—POTENTIAL INJURY: Before moving the printer, follow these guidelines to avoid personal injury or  
printer damage:  
Turn the printer off using the power switch, and then unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
Disconnect all cords and cables from the printer before moving it.  
If an optional tray is installed, then remove it from the printer. To remove the optional tray, slide the latch on the  
right side of the tray toward the front of the tray until it clicks into place.  
Use the handholds located on both sides of the printer to lift it.  
Make sure your fingers are not under the printer when you set it down.  
Before setting up the printer, make sure there is adequate clearance around it.  
Use only the power cord provided with this product or the manufacturer's authorized replacement.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Damage to the printer caused by improper moving is not covered by the printer  
warranty.  
Moving the printer to another location  
The printer and its hardware options can be safely moved to another location by following these precautions:  
Any cart used to move the printer must have a surface able to support the full footprint of the printer.  
Any cart used to move the hardware options must have a surface able to support the dimensions of the hardware  
options.  
Keep the printer in an upright position.  
Avoid severe jarring movements.  
Shipping the printer  
When shipping the printer, use the original packaging or call the place of purchase for a relocation kit.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Managing the printer  
161  
Managing the printer  
Finding advanced networking and administrator information  
This chapter covers basic administrative support tasks using the Embedded Web Server. For more advanced system  
support tasks, see the Networking Guide on the Software CD or the Embedded Web Server Administrator's Guide at  
Accessing the remote control panel  
The remote control panel on your computer screen lets you interact with the printer control panel, even when you are  
not physically near the network printer. From your computer screen, you can view the printer status and do print-  
related tasks you might normally do while standing at the network printer.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
Print a network setup page or menu settings page, and then locate the IP address in the TCP/IP section. The  
IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Press Enter to open the Web page of your printer.  
3 Click Applications.  
Note: The remote control panel requires a Java plugin to launch.  
Setting up email alerts  
Configure the printer to send you email alerts when the supplies are getting low, when the paper needs to be changed  
or added, or when there is a paper jam.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings.  
3 From the Other Settings menu, click Email Alert Setup.  
4 Select the items you want to be notified on, and then type the email addresses.  
5 Click Submit.  
Note: For information on setting up the email server, contact your system support person.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Managing the printer  
162  
Viewing reports  
You can view some reports from the Embedded Web Server. These reports are useful for assessing the status of the  
printer, network, and supplies.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Reports, and then click the type of report you want to view.  
Configuring supply notifications from the Embedded Web  
Server  
You can determine how you would like to be notified when supplies run nearly low, low, very low, or reach their  
endoflife by setting the selectable alerts.  
Notes:  
Selectable alerts can be set on the toner cartridge, imaging unit, and maintenance kit.  
All selectable alerts can be set for nearly low, low, and very low supply conditions. Not all selectable alerts can  
be set for the endoflife supply condition. Email selectable alert is available for all supply conditions.  
The percentage of estimated remaining supply that prompts the alert can be set on some supplies for some  
supply conditions.  
1 Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four  
sets of numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to load the Web page correctly.  
2 Click Settings > Print Settings > Supply Notifications.  
3 From the dropdown menu for each supply, select one of the following notification options:  
Notification  
Off  
Description  
The normal printer behavior for all supplies occurs.  
Email Only  
The printer generates an email when the supply condition is reached. The status of the  
supply appears on the menus page and status page.  
Warning  
The printer displays the warning message and generates an email about the status of the  
supply. The printer does not stop when the supply condition is reached.  
Continuable Stop1  
The printer stops processing jobs when the supply condition is reached, and the user needs  
to press a button to continue printing.  
1 The printer generates an e-mail about the status of the supply when supply notification is enabled.  
2 The printer stops when some supplies become empty to prevent damage.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Managing the printer  
163  
Notification  
Description  
Non Continuable Stop1,2  
The printer stops processing jobs when the supply condition is reached. The supply must be  
replaced to continue printing.  
1 The printer generates an e-mail about the status of the supply when supply notification is enabled.  
2 The printer stops when some supplies become empty to prevent damage.  
4 Click Submit.  
Restoring factory default settings  
If you want to keep a list of the current menu settings for reference, then print a menu settings page before restoring  
the factory default settings. For more information, see “Printing a menu settings page” on page 27.  
If you want a more comprehensive method of restoring the printer factory default settings, then perform the Wipe All  
Settings option. For more information, see “Erasing nonvolatile memory” on page 149.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Restoring factory defaults returns most printer settings to the original factory default  
settings. Exceptions include the display language, custom sizes and messages, and network/port menu settings. All  
downloads stored in the RAM are deleted. Downloads stored in the flash memory or in printer hard disk are not  
affected.  
From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings > Settings >  
> General Settings >  
> Factory Defaults >  
> Restore Now >  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
164  
Clearing jams  
By carefully selecting paper and specialty media and loading it properly, you should be able to avoid most jams. If jams  
occur, then follow the steps outlined in this chapter.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Never use any tool to remove a jam. Doing so could permanently damage the fuser.  
Avoiding jams  
Load paper properly  
Make sure paper lies flat in the tray.  
Correct loading of paper Incorrect loading of paper  
Do not remove a tray while the printer is printing.  
Do not load a tray while the printer is printing. Load it before printing, or wait for a prompt to load it.  
Do not load too much paper. Make sure the stack height is below the maximum paper fill indicator.  
Do not slide the paper into the tray. Load paper as shown in the illustration.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Clearing jams  
165  
Make sure the guides in the tray or the multipurpose feeder are properly positioned and are not pressing tightly  
against the paper or envelopes.  
Push the tray firmly into the printer after loading paper.  
Use recommended paper  
Use only recommended paper or specialty media.  
Do not load wrinkled, creased, damp, bent, or curled paper.  
Flex, fan, and straighten paper before loading it.  
Do not use paper that has been cut or trimmed by hand.  
Do not mix paper sizes, weights, or types in the same tray.  
Make sure the paper size and type are set correctly on the computer or printer control panel.  
Store paper according to manufacturer recommendations.  
Understanding jam messages and locations  
When a jam occurs, a message indicating the jam location and information to clear the jam appears on the printer  
display. Open the doors, covers, and trays indicated on the display to remove the jam.  
Notes:  
When Jam Assist is set to On, the printer automatically flushes blank pages or pages with partial prints to the  
standard bin after a jammed page has been cleared. Check your printed output stack for discarded pages.  
When Jam Recovery is set to On or Auto, the printer reprints jammed pages. However, the Auto setting does not  
guarantee that the page will reprint.  
1
2
3
4
5
7
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
166  
Jam access area  
Printer control panel message  
What to do  
1
2
3
4
5
Automatic document [x]page jam, open automatic  
Remove all paper from the ADF tray, and then remove  
the jammed paper.  
feeder (ADF)  
Standard bin  
feeder top cover. [28y.xx]  
[x]page jam, clear standard  
Remove the jammed paper.  
bin. [20y.xx]  
Front door  
[x]page jam, open front  
Open the front door, then remove the toner cartridge  
and imaging unit, and then the jammed paper.  
door. [20y.xx]  
Multipurpose feeder [x]page jam, clear manual  
Remove all paper from the multipurpose feeder, and  
then remove the jammed paper.  
feeder. [250.xx]  
Tray 1  
[x]page jam, remove tray 1 to  
Pull out tray 1 completely, then push the front duplex  
flap down, and then remove the jammed paper.  
clear duplex. [23y.xx]  
Note: You may need to open the rear door to clear  
some 23y.xx paper jams.  
6
7
Tray [x]  
[x]page jam, remove tray  
Pull out the indicated tray, and then remove the jammed  
paper.  
[x]. [24y.xx]  
Rear door  
[x]page jam, open rear  
Open the rear door, and then remove the jammed paper.  
door. [20y.xx]  
[x]page jam, open front door. [20y.xx]  
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a hot  
component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.  
1 Press the button on the right side of the printer, and then open the front door.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
167  
2 Pull the toner cartridge out using the handle.  
3 Lift the green handle, and then pull the imaging unit out of the printer.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not touch the shiny blue photoconductor drum under the imaging unit. Doing  
so may affect the quality of future print jobs.  
4 Place the imaging unit aside on a flat, smooth surface.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to direct light for more than 10 minutes.  
Extended exposure to light may cause print quality problems.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
168  
5 Lift the green flap in front of the printer.  
6 Firmly grasp the jammed paper on each side, and then gently pull it out.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
7 Insert the imaging unit by aligning the arrows on the side rails of the unit with the arrows on the side rails inside  
the printer, and then insert the imaging unit into the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
169  
8 Insert the toner cartridge by aligning the side rails of the cartridge with the arrows on the side rails inside the printer,  
and then insert the cartridge into the printer.  
9 Close the front door.  
10 From the printer control panel, touch  
models, select Next >  
to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer  
> Clear the jam, press OK >  
.
[x]page jam, open rear door. [20y.xx]  
1 Open the front door to loosen the jammed paper in the rear door.  
2 Gently pull down the rear door.  
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a hot  
component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
170  
3 Firmly grasp the jammed paper on each side, and then gently pull it out.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
4 Close the rear door, and then the front door.  
5 From the printer control panel, touch  
models, select Next >  
to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer  
> Clear the jam, press OK >  
.
[x]page jam, clear standard bin. [20y.xx]  
1 Firmly grasp the jammed paper on each side, and then gently pull it out.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
171  
2 From the printer control panel, touch  
to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer  
models, select Next >  
> Clear the jam, press OK >  
.
[x]page jam, remove tray 1 to clear duplex. [23y.xx]  
CAUTION—HOT SURFACE: The inside of the printer might be hot. To reduce the risk of injury from a hot  
component, allow the surface to cool before touching it.  
1 Pull the tray completely out of the printer.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
172  
2 Locate the blue lever, and then pull it down to release the jam.  
3 Firmly grasp the jammed paper on each side, and then gently pull it out.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
4 Insert the tray.  
5 From the printer control panel, touch  
models, select Next >  
to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer  
> Clear the jam, press OK >  
.
[x]page jam, open tray [x]. [24y.xx]  
1 Pull the tray completely out of the printer.  
Note: The message on the printer display indicates the tray where the jammed paper is located.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
173  
2 Firmly grasp the jammed paper on each side, and then gently pull it out.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
3 Insert the tray.  
4 From the printer control panel, touch  
models, select Next >  
to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer  
> Clear the jam, press OK >  
.
[x]page jam, clear manual feeder. [25y.xx]  
1 From the multipurpose feeder, firmly grasp the jammed paper on each side, and then gently pull it out.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Clearing jams  
174  
2 Flex thesheetsof paper back andforthtoloosenthem, andthenfanthem. Donot foldorcreasethe paper. Straighten  
the edges on a level surface.  
3 Reload paper into the multipurpose feeder.  
Note: Make sure the paper guide lightly rests against the edge of the paper.  
4 From the printer control panel, touch  
models, select Next >  
to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer  
> Clear the jam, press OK >  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Clearing jams  
175  
[x]page jam, open automatic feeder top cover. [28y.xx]  
1 Remove all original documents from the ADF tray.  
Note: The message is cleared when the pages are removed from the ADF tray.  
2 Open the ADF cover.  
3 Firmly grasp the jammed paper on each side, and then gently pull it out.  
Note: Make sure all paper fragments are removed.  
4 Close the ADF cover.  
5 Straighten the edges of the original documents, then load the original documents into the ADF, and then adjust the  
paper guide.  
6 From the printer control panel, touch  
models, select Next >  
to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer  
> Clear the jam, press OK >  
.
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
176  
Troubleshooting  
Understanding the printer messages  
Cartridge low [88.xy]  
You may need to order a toner cartridge. If necessary, select Continue on the printer control panel to clear the message  
and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Cartridge nearly low [88.xy]  
If necessary, select Continue on the printer control panel to clear the message and continue printing. For  
nontouchscreen printer models, press to confirm.  
Cartridge very low, [x] estimated pages remain [88.xy]  
You may need to replace the toner cartridge very soon. For more information, see the “Replacing supplies” section of  
the User’s Guide.  
If necessary, select Continue on the printer control panel to clear the message and continue printing. For  
nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Change [paper source] to [custom string] load [paper orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the correct size and type of paper in the tray, then verify that the paper size and type settings are specified in  
the Paper menu on the printer control panel, and then select Finished changing paper. For nontouchscreen printer  
models, press  
to confirm.  
Cancel the print job.  
Change [paper source] to [custom type name] load [orientation]  
Try one or more of the following  
Load the correct paper size and type in the tray, verify the paper size and type settings are specified in the Paper  
menu on the printer control panel, and then select Finished changing paper. For nontouchscreen printer models,  
press  
to confirm.  
Cancel the print job.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Troubleshooting  
177  
Change [paper source] to [paper size] load [orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the correct paper size and type in the tray, verify the paper size and type settings are specified in the Paper  
menu on the printer control panel, and then select Finished changing paper. For nontouchscreen printer models,  
press  
to confirm.  
Cancel the print job.  
Change [paper source] to [paper type] [paper size] load [orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the correct paper size and type in the tray, verify the paper size and type settings are specified in the Paper  
menu on the printer control panel, and then select Finished changing paper. For nontouchscreen printer models,  
press  
to confirm.  
Cancel the print job.  
Close flatbed cover and load originals if restarting job [2yy.xx]  
From the printer control panel, try one or more of the following:  
Select Scan from automatic feeder to continue scanning from the ADF immediately after the last successful scan  
job.  
Select Scan from flatbed to continue scanning from the scanner glass immediately after the last successful scan  
job.  
Select Finish job without further scanning to end the last successful scan job.  
Note: This does not cancel the scan job. All successfully scanned pages will be processed further for copying,  
faxing, or e-mailing.  
Select Cancel job to clear the message and cancel the scan job.  
For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Close front door  
Close the front door of the printer.  
Complex page, some data may not have printed [39]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, select Continue to ignore the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen  
printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Cancel the current print job. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Install additional printer memory.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Troubleshooting  
178  
Defective flash detected [51]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Replace the defective flash memory card.  
From the printer control panel, select Continue to ignore the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen  
printer models, press to confirm.  
Cancel the current print job.  
Error reading USB drive. Remove USB.  
An unsupported USB device is inserted. Remove the USB device, and then insert a supported one.  
Error reading USB hub. Remove hub.  
An unsupported USB hub has been inserted. Remove the USB hub, and then install a supported one.  
Fax memory full  
From the printer control panel, touch Continue to clear the message.  
Fax partition inoperative. Contact system administrator.  
Try either of the following:  
From the printer control panel, select Continue to clear the message. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Turn the printer off, and then turn it back on. If the message appears again, then contact your system support  
person or see the “Setting up the printer to fax” section of the User’s Guide.  
Fax server 'To Format' not set up. Contact system administrator.  
Try either of the following:  
From the printer control panel, select Continue to clear the message. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Complete the Fax Server setup. If the message appears again, then contact your system support person.  
Fax Station Name not set up. Contact system administrator.  
Try either of the following:  
From the printer control panel, select Continue to clear the message. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Complete the Analog Fax Setup. If the message appears again after completing the setup, then contact your system  
support person.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Troubleshooting  
179  
Fax Station Number not set up. Contact system administrator.  
Try either of the following:  
From the printer control panel, select Continue to clear the message. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Complete the Analog Fax Setup. If the message appears again after completing the setup, then contact your system  
support person.  
Imaging unit low [84.xy]  
You may need to order an imaging unit. If necessary, select Continue on the printer control panel to clear the message  
and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Imaging unit nearly low [84.xy]  
If necessary, select Continue on the printer control panel to clear the message and continue printing. For  
nontouchscreen printer models, press to confirm.  
Imaging unit very low, [x] estimated pages remain [84.xy]  
You may need to replace the imaging unit very soon. For more information, see the "Replacing supplies" section of the  
User’s Guide.  
If necessary, select Continue on the printer control panel to clear the message and continue printing. For  
nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Incorrect paper size, open [paper source] [34]  
Note: The paper source can be a tray or a feeder.  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the correct size of paper in the paper source.  
From the printer control panel, select Continue to clear the message and print using a different paper source. For  
nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Check the length and width guides of the paper source and make sure the paper is loaded properly.  
Make sure the correct paper size and type are specified in the Printing Preferences or in the Print dialog.  
Make sure the paper size and type are specified in the Paper menu on the printer control panel.  
Make sure that the paper size is correctly set. For example, if Multipurpose Feeder Size is set to Universal, then  
make sure the paper is large enough for the data being printed.  
Cancel the print job.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Troubleshooting  
180  
Insufficient memory for Flash Memory Defragment operation [37]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, select Continue to stop the defragmentation and continue printing. For  
nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Delete fonts, macros, and other data from the printer memory.  
Install additional printer memory.  
Insufficient memory, some Held Jobs were deleted [37]  
The printer deleted some held jobs in order to process current jobs.  
Select Continue to clear the message. For non-touch-screen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Insufficient memory, some held jobs will not be restored [37]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, select Continue to clear the message. For non-touch-screen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Delete other held jobs to free up additional printer memory.  
Insufficient memory to collate job [37]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, select Continue to print the part of the job already stored and begin collating the  
rest of the print job. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Cancel the current print job.  
Insufficient memory to support Resource Save feature [35]  
Install additional printer memory or select Continue on the printer control panel to disable Resource Save, clear the  
message, and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Load manual feeder with [custom string] [paper orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the feeder with the correct size and type of paper.  
Depending on your printer model, touch Continue or press  
to clear the message and continue printing.  
is selected, then the printer automatically  
Note: If no paper is loaded in the feeder when Continue or  
overrides the request, and then prints from an automatically selected tray.  
Cancel the current job.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Troubleshooting  
181  
Load manual feeder with [custom type name] [paper orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the multipurpose feeder with the correct size and type of paper.  
Depending on your printer model, touch Continue or press  
to clear the message and continue printing.  
Note: If no paper is loaded in the feeder when Continue or  
is selected, then the printer manually overrides  
the request, and then prints from an automatically selected tray.  
Cancel the current job.  
Load manual feeder with [paper size] [paper orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the multipurpose feeder with the correct size of paper.  
Depending on your printer model, touch Continue or press  
to clear the message and continue printing.  
is selected, then the printer manually overrides  
Note: If no paper is loaded in the feeder when Continue or  
the request, and then prints from an automatically selected tray.  
Cancel the current job.  
Load manual feeder with [paper type] [paper size] [paper orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the multipurpose feeder with the correct size and type of paper.  
Depending on your printer model, touch Continue or press  
to clear the message and continue printing.  
Note: If no paper is loaded in the feeder when Continue or  
is selected, then the printer manually overrides  
the request, and then prints from an automatically selected tray.  
Cancel the current job.  
Load [paper source] with [custom string] [paper orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the tray or feeder with the correct size and type of paper.  
To use the tray that has the correct size or type of paper, select Finished loading paper on the printer control panel.  
For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Note: If the printer finds a tray that has the correct size and type of paper, then it feeds from that tray. If the  
printer cannot find a tray that has the correct size and type of paper, then it prints from the default paper  
source.  
Cancel the current job.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Troubleshooting  
182  
Load [paper source] with [custom type name] [paper orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the tray or feeder with the correct size and type of paper.  
To use the tray that has the correct size or type of paper, select Finished loading paper on the printer control panel.  
For nontouchscreen printer models, press to confirm.  
Note: If the printer finds a tray that has the correct size and type of paper, then it feeds from that tray. If the  
printer cannot find a tray that has the correct size and type of paper, then it prints from the default paper  
source.  
Cancel the current job.  
Load [paper source] with [paper size] [paper orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the tray or feeder with the correct size of paper.  
To use the tray or feeder that has the correct size of paper, select Finished loading paper on the printer control  
panel. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Note: If the printer finds a tray that has the correct size and type of paper, then it feeds from that tray. If the  
printer cannot find a tray that has the correct size and type of paper, then it prints from the default paper  
source.  
Cancel the current job.  
Load [paper source] with [paper type] [paper size] [paper orientation]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Load the tray or feeder with the correct size and type of paper.  
To use the tray or feeder that has the correct size and type of paper, select Finished loading paper on the printer  
control panel. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Note: If the printer finds a tray that has the correct size and type of paper, then it feeds from that tray. If the  
printer cannot find a tray that has the correct size and type of paper, then it prints from the default paper  
source.  
Cancel the current job.  
Maintenance kit low [80.xy]  
You may need to order a maintenance kit. For more information, visit the Lexmark support Web site at  
http://support.lexmark.com or contact customer support, and then report the message.  
If necessary, select Continue to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer models,  
press  
to confirm.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Troubleshooting  
183  
Maintenance kit nearly low [80.xy]  
For more information, visit the Lexmark support Web site at http://support.lexmark.com or contact customer support,  
and then report the message.  
If necessary, select Continue to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer models,  
press  
to confirm.  
Maintenance kit very low, [x] estimated pages remain [80.xy]  
You may need to replace the maintenance kit very soon. For more information, visit the Lexmark support Web site at  
http://support.lexmark.com or contact customer support, and then report the message.  
If necessary, select Continue on the printer control panel to clear the message and continue printing. For  
nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Memory full, cannot print faxes  
From the printer control panel, select Continue to clear the message without printing. For nontouchscreen printer  
models, press to confirm.  
Note: Held faxes will attempt to print after the printer restarts.  
Memory full, cannot send faxes  
1 From the printer control panel, select Continue to clear the message and cancel the fax job. For nontouchscreen  
printer models, press  
to confirm.  
2 Do either of the following:  
Reduce the fax resolution, and then resend the fax job.  
Reduce the number of pages in the fax, and then resend fax job.  
Memory full [38]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, select Cancel job to clear the message. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Install additional printer memory.  
Network [x] software error [54]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, select Continue to continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Turn off the printer, wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the printer back on.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Troubleshooting  
184  
Update the network firmware in the printer or print server. For more information, visit the Lexmark support Web  
No analog phone line connected to modem, fax is disabled.  
Connect the printer to an analog phone line.  
NonLexmark [supply type], see User’s Guide [33.xy]  
Note: The supply type can be toner cartridge or imaging unit.  
The printer has detected a nonLexmark supply or part installed in the printer.  
Your Lexmark printer is designed to function best with genuine Lexmark supplies and parts. Use of third-party supplies  
or parts may affect the performance, reliability, or life of the printer and its imaging components.  
All life indicators are designed to function with Lexmark supplies and parts and may deliver unpredictable results if  
third-party supplies or parts are used. Imaging component usage beyond the intended life may damage your Lexmark  
printer or associated components.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Use of third-party supplies or parts can affect warranty coverage. Damage caused by  
the use of third-party supplies or parts may not be covered by the warranty.  
To accept any and all of these risks and to proceed with the use of non-genuine supplies or parts in your printer, press  
and hold  
and the # button on the printer control panel simultaneously for 15 seconds.  
For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
and  
on the printer control panel simultaneously for 15 seconds  
to clear the message and continue printing.  
If you do not wish to accept these risks, then remove the third-party supply or part from your printer, and then install  
a genuine Lexmark supply or part.  
Note: For a list of supported supplies, see the “Ordering supplies” section of the User's Guide or visit  
Not enough free space in flash memory for resources [52]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, select Continue to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen  
printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Delete fonts, macros, and other data stored in the flash memory.  
Upgrade to a larger capacity flash memory card.  
Note: Downloaded fonts and macros that are not previously stored in the flash memory are deleted.  
Printer had to restart. Last job may be incomplete.  
From the printer control panel, touch  
models, press to confirm.  
to clear the message and continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Troubleshooting  
185  
For more information, visit http://support.lexmark.com or contact customer support.  
Reinstall missing or unresponsive cartridge [31.xy]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Check if the toner cartridge is missing. If missing, install the toner cartridge.  
For information on installing the cartridge, see the “Replacing supplies” section of the User’s Guide.  
If the toner cartridge is installed, then remove the unresponsive toner cartridge, and then reinstall it.  
Note: If the message appears after reinstalling the supply, then the cartridge is defective. Replace the toner  
cartridge.  
Reinstall missing or unresponsive imaging unit [31.xy]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Check if the imaging unit is missing. If missing, install the imaging unit.  
For information on installing the imaging unit, see the “Replacing supplies” section of the User’s Guide.  
If the imaging unit is installed, then remove the unresponsive imaging unit, and then reinstall it.  
Note: If the message appears after reinstalling the supply, then the imaging unit is defective. Replace the  
imaging unit.  
Remove paper from standard output bin  
Remove the paper stack from the standard bin. The printer automatically detects paper removal and resumes printing.  
If removing the paper does not clear the message, then select Continue on the printer control panel. For non-touch-  
screen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Replace all originals if restarting job.  
From the printer control panel, try one or more of the following:  
Select Cancel job to clear the message and cancel the scan job.  
Select Scan from automatic feeder to continue scanning from the ADF immediately after the last successful scan  
job.  
Select Scan from flatbed to continue scanning from the scanner immediately after the last successful scan job.  
Select Finish job without further scanning to end the last successful scan job.  
Select Restart job to restart the scan job with the same settings from the previous scan job.  
For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Replace cartridge, 0 estimated pages remain [88.xy]  
Replace the toner cartridge to clear the message and continue printing. For more information, see the instruction sheet  
that came with the supply or see the “Replacing supplies” section of the User’s Guide.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Troubleshooting  
186  
Note: If you do not have a replacement cartridge, then see the “Ordering supplies” section of the User’s Guide or  
visit www.lexmark.com.  
Replace cartridge, printer region mismatch [42.xy]  
Install a toner cartridge that matches the region number of the printer. x indicates the value of the printer region. y  
indicates the value of the cartridge region. x and y can have the following values:  
Printer and toner cartridge regions  
Region number  
Region  
0
1
2
3
4
5
9
Global  
United States, Canada  
European Economic Area (EEA), Switzerland  
Asia Pacific, Australia, New Zealand  
Latin America  
Africa, Middle East, rest of Europe  
Invalid  
Notes:  
The x and y values represent .xyin the code that appears on the printer control panel.  
The x and y values must match for printing to continue.  
Replace defective imaging unit [31.xy]  
Replace the defective imaging unit to clear the message. For more information, see the instruction sheet that came  
with the supply or see the “Replacing supplies” section of the User’s Guide.  
Note: If you do not have a replacement imaging unit, then see the “Ordering supplies” section of the User’s Guide or  
visit www.lexmark.com.  
Replace imaging unit, 0 estimated pages remain [84.xy]  
Replace the imaging unit to clear the message and continue printing. For more information, see the instruction sheet  
that came with the supply or see the “Replacing supplies” section of the User’s Guide.  
Note: If you do not have a replacement imaging unit, then see the “Ordering supplies” section of the User’s Guide or  
visit www.lexmark.com.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
187  
Replace jammed originals if restarting job.  
From the printer control panel, try one or more of the following:  
Select Cancel job to clear the message and cancel the scan job. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Select Scan from automatic feeder to continue scanning from the ADF immediately after the last successful scan  
job. For nontouchscreen printer models, press to confirm.  
Select Scan from flatbed to continue scanning from the scanner immediately after the last successful scan job. For  
nontouchscreen printer models, press to confirm.  
Select Finish job without further scanning to end the last successful scan job. For nontouchscreen printer models,  
press to confirm.  
Select Restart job to restart the scan job with the same settings from the previous scan job. For nontouchscreen  
printer models, press to confirm.  
Replace maintenance kit, 0 estimated pages remain [80.xy]  
The printer is scheduled for maintenance. For more information, visit the Lexmark support Web site at  
http://support.lexmark.com or contact your service representative, and then report the message.  
Replace unsupported cartridge [32.xy]  
Remove the toner cartridge, and then install a supported one to clear the message and continue printing. For more  
information, see the instruction sheet that came with the supply or see the “Replacing supplies” section of the User’s  
Guide.  
Note: If you do not have a replacement cartridge, then see the “Ordering supplies” section of the User’s Guide or  
visit www.lexmark.com.  
Replace unsupported imaging unit [32.xy]  
Remove the imaging unit, and then install a supported one to clear the message and continue printing. For more  
information, see the instruction sheet that came with the supply or see the “Replacing supplies” section of the User’s  
Guide.  
Note: If you do not have a replacement imaging unit, then see the “Ordering supplies” section of the User’s Guide or  
visit www.lexmark.com.  
Scanner automatic feeder cover open  
Close the ADF cover.  
Scanner disabled by admin [840.01]  
Print without the scanner, or contact your system support person.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Troubleshooting  
188  
Scanner disabled. Contact system administrator if problem persists. [840.02]  
From the printer control panel, try one or more of the following:  
Select Continue with scanner disabled to return to the home screen, and then contact your system support person.  
Select Reboot and automatically enable scanner to cancel the job.  
Note: This attempts to enable the scanner.  
For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Scanner jam, remove all originals from the scanner [2yy.xx]  
Remove the jammed paper from the scanner.  
Scanner jam, remove jammed originals from the scanner [2yy.xx]  
Remove the jammed paper from the scanner.  
Serial option [x] error [54]  
Try one or more of the following:  
Make sure that the serial cable is properly connected and is the correct one for the serial port.  
Make sure that the serial interface parameters (protocol, baud, parity, and data bits) are set correctly on the printer  
and computer.  
From the printer control panel, select Continue to continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Turn off the printer, and then turn it back on.  
SMTP server not set up. Contact system administrator.  
From the printer control panel, select Continue to clear the message. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Note: If the message appears again, then contact your system support person.  
Standard network software error [54]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control panel, select Continue to continue printing. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Turn off the printer and then turn it back on.  
Update the network firmware in the printer or print server. For more information, visit the Lexmark support Web  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Troubleshooting  
189  
Standard USB port disabled [56]  
From the printer control panel, select Continue to clear the message. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Notes:  
The printer discards any data received through the USB port.  
Make sure the USB Buffer menu is not set to Disabled.  
Supply needed to complete job  
Do either of the following:  
Install the missing supply to complete the job.  
Cancel the current job.  
Too many flash options installed [58]  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
3 Remove the extra flash memory.  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
5 Turn the printer back on.  
Too many trays attached [58]  
1 Turn off the printer.  
2 Unplug the power cord from the electrical outlet.  
3 Remove the extra trays.  
4 Connect the power cord to a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
5 Turn the printer back on.  
Unformatted flash detected [53]  
Try one or more of the following:  
From the printer control, select Continue to stop the defragmentation and continue printing. For nontouchscreen  
printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Format the flash memory.  
Note: If the error message remains, then the flash memory may be defective and need to be replaced.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Troubleshooting  
190  
Weblink server not set up. Contact system administrator.  
Select Continue to clear the message. For nontouchscreen printer models, press  
to confirm.  
Note: If the message appears again, then contact your system support person.  
Solving printer problems  
Basic printer problems  
The printer is not responding  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Turn on the printer.  
Make sure the printer is turned on.  
Is the printer turned on?  
Step 2  
Press the Sleep button Go to step 3.  
to wake the printer  
from Sleep mode or  
Check if the printer is in Sleep mode or Hibernate mode.  
Hibernate mode.  
Is the printer in Sleep mode or Hibernate mode?  
Step 3  
Go to step 4.  
Plug one end of the  
power cord into the  
printer and the other to  
a properly grounded  
electrical outlet.  
Check if one end of the power cord is plugged into the printer and the  
other to a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
Is the power cord plugged into the printer and a properly grounded  
electrical outlet?  
Step 4  
Unplug the other  
Go to step 5.  
electrical equipment,  
and then turn on the  
printer. If the printer  
does not work, then  
reconnect the other  
electrical equipment.  
Check other electrical equipment plugged into the electrical outlet.  
Does other electrical equipment work?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Troubleshooting  
191  
Action  
Step 5  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 6.  
Makesureto matchthe  
following:  
Check if the cables connecting the printer and the computer are inserted  
in the correct ports.  
The USB symbol on  
the cable with the  
USB symbol on the  
printer  
Are the cables inserted in the correct ports?  
The appropriate  
Ethernet cable with  
the Ethernet port  
Step 6  
Turn on the switch or Go to step 7.  
reset the breaker.  
Make sure the electrical outlet is not turned off by a switch or breaker.  
Is the electrical outlet turned off by a switch or breaker?  
Step 7  
Connect the printer  
power cord directly to  
a properly grounded  
electrical outlet.  
Go to step 8.  
Check if the printer is plugged into any surge protectors, uninterruptible  
power supplies, or extension cords.  
Is the printer plugged into any surge protectors, uninterruptible power  
supplies, or extension cords?  
Step 8  
Go to step 9.  
Connect the printer  
cable securely to the  
printer and the  
computer, print server,  
option, or other  
Check if one end of the printer cable is plugged into a port on the printer  
and the other to the computer, print server, option, or other network  
device.  
network device.  
Is the printer cable securely attached to the printer and the computer,  
print server, option, or other network device?  
Step 9  
Go to step 10.  
Turn off the printer,  
remove all packing  
materials, then  
reinstall the hardware  
options, and then turn  
on the printer.  
Makesureto installall hardwareoptionsproperlyandremoveanypacking  
material.  
Are all hardware options properly installed and all packing material  
removed?  
Step 10  
Go to step 11.  
Go to step 12.  
Use correct printer  
driver settings.  
Check if you have selected the correct port settings in the printer driver.  
Are the port settings correct?  
Step 11  
Install the correct  
printer driver.  
Check the installed printer driver.  
Is the correct printer driver installed?  
Step 12  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Turn off the printer, then wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the  
printer back on.  
Is the printer working?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
192  
Printer display is blank  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
Press the Sleep button on the printer control panel.  
Does Readyappear on the printer display?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Turn off the printer,  
and then contact  
Turn off the printer, then wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the  
printer back on.  
Do Please waitand Readyappear on the printer display?  
Hardware and internal option problems  
Cannot detect internal option  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
Turn off the printer, then wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn on the  
printer.  
Does the internal option operate correctly?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Connect the internal  
option to the controller  
board.  
Check if the internal option is properly installed in the controller board.  
a Turnofftheprinterusingthepowerswitch,andthenunplugthepower  
cord from the electrical outlet.  
b Make sure the internal option is installed in the appropriate connector  
in the controller board.  
c Connect the power cord to the printer, then to a properly grounded  
electrical outlet, and then turn on the printer.  
Is the internal option properly installed in the controller board?  
Step 3  
Go to step 4.  
Reinstall the internal  
option.  
Print a menu settings page, and then check to see if the internal option is  
listed in the Installed Features list.  
Is the internal option listed in the menu settings page?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
193  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 4  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Check if the internal option is selected.  
It may be necessary to manually add the internal option in the printer  
driver to make it available for print jobs. For more information, see  
b Resend the print job.  
Does the internal option operate correctly?  
Tray problems  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a Pull out the tray, and then do one or more of the following:  
Check for paper jams or misfeeds.  
Check if the paper size indicators on the paper guides are aligned  
with the paper size indicators on the tray.  
If you are printing on customsize paper, then make sure that the  
paper guides rest against the edges of the paper.  
Make sure the paper is below the maximum paper fill indicator.  
Make sure paper lies flat in the tray.  
b Check if the tray closes properly.  
Is the tray working?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
a Turn off the printer, then wait about 10 seconds, and then turn the  
printer back on.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the tray working?  
Step 3  
Go to step 4.  
Reinstall the tray. For  
more information, see  
the setup  
documentation that  
came with the tray.  
Check if the tray is installed and recognized by the printer.  
Print a menu settings page, and then check if the tray is listed in the  
Installed Features list.  
Is the tray listed in the menu settings page?  
Step 4  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Check if the tray is available in the printer driver.  
Note: If necessary, manually add the tray in the printer driver to make it  
available for print jobs. For more information, see “Adding available  
Is the tray available in the printer driver?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
194  
Paper feed problems  
Jammed pages are not reprinted  
Action  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Turn on jam recovery.  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
Settings > General Settings > Print Recovery > Jam Recovery  
2 Select On or Auto.  
3 Depending on your printer model, press  
or touch Submit.  
b Resend the pages that did not print.  
Were the jammed pages reprinted?  
Paper frequently jams  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a Pull out the tray, and then do one or more of the following:  
Make sure paper lies flat in the tray.  
Check if the paper size indicators on the paper guides are aligned  
with the paper size indicators on the tray.  
Check if the paper guides are aligned against the edges of the  
paper.  
Make sure the paper is below the maximum paper fill indicator.  
Check if you are printing on a recommended paper size and type.  
b Insert the tray properly.  
If jam recovery is enabled, then the print jobs will reprint  
automatically.  
Do paper jams still occur frequently?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
The problem is solved.  
a Load paper from a fresh package.  
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store paper in  
its original wrapper until you use it.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do paper jams still occur frequently?  
Step 3  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
a Review the tips on avoiding jams. For more information, see “Avoiding  
b Follow the recommendations, and then resend the print job.  
Do paper jams still occur frequently?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
195  
Paper jam message remains after jam is cleared  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
a Do either of the following:  
For touchscreen printer models, touch  
For nontouchscreen printer models, select Next >  
the jam, press OK >  
or Done.  
> Clear  
.
b Follow the instructions on the printer display.  
Does the paper jam message remain?  
Solving print problems  
Printing problems  
Incorrect characters print  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Deactivate Hex Trace Go to step 2.  
mode.  
Make sure the printer is not in Hex Trace mode.  
Note: If Ready Hexappears on the printer display, then turn off the  
printer, and then turn it back on to deactivate Hex Trace mode.  
Is the printer in Hex Trace mode?  
Step 2  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
a From the printer control panel, select Standard Network or  
Network [x], and then set SmartSwitch to On.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do incorrect characters print?  
Job prints from the wrong tray or on the wrong paper  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a Check if you are printing on paper that is supported by the tray.  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the job print from the correct tray or on the correct paper?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Troubleshooting  
196  
Action  
Step 2  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
a From the Paper menu on the printer control panel, set the paper size  
and type to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the job print from the correct tray or on the correct paper?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Go to step 4.  
a Depending on your operating system, open Printing Preferences or  
the Print dialog, and then specify the paper type.  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the job print from the correct tray or on the correct paper?  
Step 4  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Check if the trays are not linked.  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the job print from the correct tray or on the correct paper?  
Large jobs do not collate  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a From the Finishing menu on the printer control panel, set Collate to  
“(1,2,3) (1,2,3).”  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the job print and collate correctly?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
a From the printer software, set Collate to “(1,2,3) (1,2,3).”  
Note: Setting Collate to “(1,1,1) (2,2,2)” in the software overrides  
the setting in the Finishing menu.  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the job print and collate correctly?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Reduce the complexity of the print job by eliminating the number and size  
of fonts, the number and complexity of images, and the number of pages  
in the job.  
Did the job print and collate correctly?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
197  
Multiplelanguage PDF files do not print  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a Check if the print options for the PDF output are set to embed all fonts.  
For more information, see the documentation that came with Adobe  
Acrobat.  
b Generate a new PDF file, and then resend the print job.  
Do the files print?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Open the document you want to print in Adobe Acrobat.  
b Click File > Print > Advanced > Print As Image > OK > OK.  
Do the files print?  
Print jobs do not print  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a From the document you are trying to print, open the Print dialog and  
check if you have selected the correct printer.  
Note: If the printer is not the default printer, then you must select  
the printer for each document that you want to print.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do the jobs print?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
The problem is solved. Go to step 4.  
a Check if the printer is plugged in and turned on, and if Readyappears  
on the printer display.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do the jobs print?  
Step 3  
Ifan error message appears on the printerdisplay, thenclear the message.  
Note: The printer continues to print after clearing the message.  
Do the jobs print?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
198  
Action  
Step 4  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Go to step 5.  
a Check if the ports (USB, serial, or Ethernet) are working and if the  
cables are securely connected to the computer and the printer.  
Note: For more information, see the setup documentation that  
came with the printer.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do the jobs print?  
Step 5  
The problem is solved. Go to step 6.  
a Turn off the printer, wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the  
printer back on.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do the jobs print?  
Step 6  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Remove, and then reinstall the printer software. For more  
Note: The printer software is available at  
b Resend the print job.  
Do the jobs print?  
Print job takes longer than expected  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
Change the environmental settings of the printer.  
a From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
Settings > General Settings  
b Select EcoMode or Quiet Mode, and then select Off.  
Note: Disabling Eco-Mode or Quiet Mode may increase the  
consumption of energy or supplies, or both.  
Did the job print?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
Reduce the number and size of fonts, the number and complexity of  
images, and the number of pages in the print job, and then resend the job  
Did the job print?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
199  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Go to step 4.  
a Remove held jobs stored in the printer memory.  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the job print?  
Step 4  
The problem is solved. Go to step 5.  
a Disable the Page Protect feature.  
From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
Settings > General Settings > Print Recovery > Page Protect > Off  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the job print?  
Step 5  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Check if the cable connections to the printer and print server are  
secure. For moreinformation, seethesetupdocumentation thatcame  
with the printer.  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the job print?  
Printing slows down  
Notes:  
When printing using narrow paper, the printer prints at a reduced speed to prevent damage to the fuser.  
The printer speed may be reduced when printing for long periods of time, or printing at elevated temperatures.  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a Make sure the size of the paper loaded in the tray matches the fuser  
type.  
Note: Use a 110-volt fuser for printing on letter-size paper and a  
220-volt fuser for printing on A4size paper.  
b Resend the print job.  
Does the print speed increase?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Replace the fuser. For more information on installing the fuser, see  
the instruction sheet that came with the part.  
b Resend the print job.  
Does the print speed increase?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
200  
Tray linking does not work  
Notes:  
The trays can detect paper length.  
The multipurpose feeder does not automatically detect the paper size. You must set the size from the Paper  
Size/Type menu.  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a Open the trays, and then check if they contain paper of the same size  
and type.  
Check if the paper guides are in the correct positions for the size  
of the paper loaded in each tray.  
Check if the paper size indicators on the paper guides are aligned  
with the paper size indicators on the tray.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do the trays link correctly?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a From the printer control panel, set the paper size and type in thePaper  
menu to match the paper loaded in the trays to be linked.  
Note: The paper size and type must match for trays to be linked.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do the trays link correctly?  
Unexpected page breaks occur  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
Adjust the print timeout settings.  
a From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
Settings > General Settings > Timeouts > Print Timeout  
b Select a higher setting and then, depending on your printer model,  
select  
or Submit.  
c Resend the print job.  
Did the file print correctly?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Check the original file for manual page breaks.  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the file print correctly?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
201  
Print quality problems  
Characters have jagged or uneven edges  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 2.  
Select a font that is  
supported by the  
printer.  
a Print a font sample listto checkif thefonts you areusing are supported  
by the printer.  
1 From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
Menus > Reports > Print Fonts  
2 Select PCL Fonts or PostScript Fonts.  
b Resend the print job.  
Are you using fonts that are supported by the printer?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Check if the fonts installed on the computer are supported by the printer.  
Are the fonts installed on the computer supported by the printer?  
Clipped pages or images  
Leading edge  
ABCD
ABCD
ABCD
Trailing edge  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved.  
Go to step 2.  
a Move the width and length guides in the tray to the correct positions  
for the paper loaded.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the page or image clipped?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
202  
Action  
Step 2  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 3.  
Do one or more of the  
following:  
From the printer control panel, set the paper size and type in the Paper  
menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Specify the paper  
size from the tray  
settings to match  
the paper loaded in  
the tray.  
Do the paper size and type match the paper loaded in the tray?  
Change the paper  
loaded in the tray  
to match the paper  
size specified in the  
tray settings.  
Step 3  
Go to step 4.  
The problem is solved.  
The problem is solved.  
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper size from  
Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the page or image clipped?  
Step 4  
Contact customer  
a Reinstall the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge.  
2 Remove the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
3 Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the page or image clipped?  
Compressed images appear on prints  
Note: Printing on letter-size paper using a 220-volt fuser compresses images.  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a Make sure the size of the paper loaded in the tray matches the fuser  
type.  
Note: Use a 110-volt fuser for printing on letter-size paper and a  
220-volt fuser for printing on A4size paper.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do compressed images still appear?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
203  
Action  
Step 2  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Replace the fuser. For more information on installing the fuser, see  
the instruction sheet that came with the part.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do compressed images still appear?  
Gray background on prints  
Leading edge  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
Trailing edge  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a From the Quality Menu on the printer control panel, decrease the  
toner darkness.  
Note: 8 is the factory default setting.  
b Resend the print job.  
Did the gray background disappear from the prints?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
Reinstall the imaging unit and the toner cartridge.  
a Remove the toner cartridge.  
b Remove the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to light  
can cause print quality problems.  
c Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
d Resend the print job.  
Did the gray background disappear from the prints?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Did the gray background disappear from the prints?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
204  
Horizontal voids appear on prints  
Leading edge  
Trailing edge  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
The problem is solved.  
The problem is solved.  
a Make sure your software program is using a correct fill pattern.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do horizontal voids appear on prints?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
a Load the specified tray or feeder with a recommended type of paper.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do horizontal voids appear on prints?  
Step 3  
a Redistribute the toner in the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.  
2 Firmly shake the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
3 Reinstall the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do horizontal voids appear on prints?  
Step 4  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Do horizontal voids appear on prints?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
205  
Incorrect margins on prints  
ABCD  
ABCD  
ABCD  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a Move the width and length guides in the tray to the correct positions  
for the paper size loaded.  
b Resend the print job.  
Are the margins correct?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Do one or more of the  
following:  
From the printer control panel, set the paper size in the Paper menu to  
match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Specify the paper  
size from the tray  
settings to match  
the paper loaded in  
the tray.  
Does the paper size match the paper loaded in the tray?  
Change the paper  
loaded in the tray  
to match the paper  
size specified in the  
tray settings.  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper size from  
Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Are the margins correct?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
206  
Paper curl  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Adjust the width and  
length guides.  
Move the width and length guides in the tray to the correct positions for  
the size of the paper loaded.  
Are the width and length guides positioned correctly?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
Specify the paper type  
and weight from the  
tray settings to match  
the paper loaded in the  
tray.  
From the printer control panel, set the paper type and weight in the Paper  
menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Do the paper type and weight match the type and weight of the paper in  
the tray?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved.  
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type and  
weight from Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the paper still curled?  
Step 4  
Go to step 5.  
The problem is solved.  
The problem is solved.  
a Remove the paper from the tray, and then turn it over.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the paper still curled?  
Step 5  
Contact customer  
a Load paper from a fresh package.  
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store paper in  
its original wrapper until you use it.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the paper still curled?  
Print irregularities  
Leading edge  
)
)
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
Trailing edge  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
207  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a Move the width and length guides in the tray to the correct positions  
for the size of the paper loaded in the tray.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do print irregularities still appear?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
Specify the paper size  
and type from the tray  
settings to match the  
paper loaded in the  
tray.  
From the printer control panel, set the paper size and type in the Paper  
menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Do the printer settings match the type and weight of the paper loaded in  
the tray?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved.  
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type and  
weight from Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do print irregularities still appear?  
Step 4  
From the printer  
control panel, set the  
paper texture in the  
Paper menu to match  
the paper loaded in the  
tray.  
Go to step 5.  
Check if the paper loaded in the tray has texture or rough finishes.  
Are you printing on textured or rough paper?  
Step 5  
Go to step 6.  
The problem is solved.  
a Load paper from a fresh package.  
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store paper in  
its original wrapper until you use it.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do print irregularities still appear?  
Step 6  
Contact customer  
k.com or your service  
representative.  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Do print irregularities still appear?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
208  
Print is too dark  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a From the Quality menu on the printer control panel, reduce the toner  
darkness.  
Note: 8 is the factory default setting.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print still too dark?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Do one or more of the  
following:  
a From the printer control panel, set the paper type, texture and weight  
in the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Specify the paper  
type, texture, and  
weight from the  
tray settings to  
match the paper  
loaded in the tray.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the tray set to the type, texture, and weight of the paper loaded?  
Change the paper  
loaded in the tray  
to match the paper  
type, texture and  
weight specified in  
the tray settings.  
Step 3  
Go to step 4.  
The problem is solved.  
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type, texture  
and weight from Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print still too dark?  
Step 4  
From the printer  
control panel, change  
the texture settings in  
the Paper Texture  
menu to match the  
paper you are printing  
on.  
Go to step 5.  
Check if the paper loaded in the tray has texture or rough finishes.  
Are you printing on textured or rough paper?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
209  
Action  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved.  
Step 5  
Go to step 6.  
a Load paper from a fresh package.  
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store paper in  
its original wrapper until you use it.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print still too dark?  
Step 6  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Is the print still too dark?  
Print is too light  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a Fromthe Qualitymenu on the printercontrolpanel, increasethetoner  
darkness.  
Note: 8 is the factory default setting.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print still too light?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
Change the paper type,  
texture, and weight to  
match the paper  
From the printer control panel, set the paper type, texture, and weight in  
the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
loaded in the tray.  
Is the tray set to the type, texture, and weight of the paper loaded?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved.  
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type, texture,  
and weight from Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print still too light?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
210  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 4  
From the printer  
control panel, change  
the texture settings in  
the Paper Texture  
menu to match the  
paper you are printing  
on.  
Go to step 5.  
Make sure that the paper has no texture or rough finishes.  
Are you printing on textured or rough paper?  
Step 5  
Go to step 6.  
The problem is solved.  
a Load paper from a fresh package.  
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store paper in  
its original wrapper until you use it.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print still too light?  
Step 6  
Go to step 7.  
The problem is solved.  
a Redistribute the toner in the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.  
2 Firmly shake the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
3 Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print still too light?  
Step 7  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Is the print still too light?  
Printer is printing blank pages  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
211  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a Check if there is packing material left on the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.  
2 Checkifthepackingmaterialisproperlyremovedfromtheimaging  
unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
3 Reinstall the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the printer still printing blank pages?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
The problem is solved.  
a Redistribute the toner in the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.  
2 Firmly shake the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
3 Reinstall the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the printer still printing blank pages?  
Step 3  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Is the printer still printing blank pages?  
Printer is printing solid black pages  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
212  
Action  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved.  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
a Reinstall the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
2 Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the printer printing solid black pages?  
Step 2  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Is the printer printing solid black pages?  
Repeating defects appear on prints  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
1 Check if the  
distance between  
the defects equal  
to 80 mm (3.15 in.)  
Measure the distance between the defects.  
Check for a distance between the defects that equals:  
97 mm (3.82 in.)  
47 mm (1.85 in.)  
38 mm (1.5 in.)  
2 Take note of the  
distance, and then  
contact customer  
Is the distance between defects equal to one of the listed measurements?  
your service  
representative.  
Step 2  
Contact customer  
rk.com or your service  
representative.  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Do the repeating defects still appear?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
213  
Shadow images appear on prints  
Leading edge  
ABCD  
ABCD  
ABCD  
ABCD  
Trailing edge  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 2.  
Load paper with the  
correct paper type and  
weight in the tray.  
Load paper with the correct paper type and weight in the tray.  
Is paper with the correct paper type and weight loaded in the tray?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
Change the paper  
loaded in the tray to  
match the paper type  
and weight specified in  
the tray settings.  
From the printer control panel, set the paper type and weight in the Paper  
menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Is the tray set to the type and weight of the paper loaded?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved.  
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type and  
weight from Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do shadow images still appear on prints?  
Step 4  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Do shadow images still appear on prints?  
Skewed print  
)
)
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
214  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a Move the width and length guides in the tray to the correct positions  
for the size of the paper loaded.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print still skewed?  
Step 2  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
a Check if you are printing on a paper that is supported by the tray.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print still skewed?  
Streaked horizontal lines appear on prints  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a Depending on your operating system, specify the tray or feeder from  
Printing Preferences or the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do streaked horizontal lines appear on prints?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
Change the paper type  
and weight to match  
the paper loaded in the  
tray.  
From the printer control panel, set the paper type and weight in the Paper  
menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Do the paper type and weight match the type and weight of the paper in  
the tray?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved.  
a Load paper from a fresh package.  
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store paper in  
its original wrapper until you use it.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do streaked horizontal lines appear on prints?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
215  
Action  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved.  
Step 4  
Go to step 5.  
a Reinstall the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
2 Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do streaked horizontal lines appear on prints?  
Step 5  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Do streaked horizontal lines appear on prints?  
Streaked vertical lines appear on prints  
Leading edge  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
Trailing edge  
Action  
Step 1  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a Depending on your operating system, specify the paper type, texture,  
and weight from Printing Preferences or from the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do streaked vertical lines appear on prints?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Do one or more of the  
following:  
From the printer control panel, set the paper texture, type, and weight in  
the Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Specify the paper  
texture, type, and  
weight from the  
tray settings to  
Do the paper texture, type, and weight match the paper in the tray?  
match the paper  
loaded in the tray.  
Change the paper  
loaded in the tray  
to match the paper  
texture, type, and  
weight specified in  
the tray settings.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
216  
Action  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved.  
Step 3  
Go to step 4.  
a Load paper from a fresh package.  
Note: Paper absorbs moisture due to high humidity. Store paper in  
its original wrapper until you use it.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do streaked vertical lines appear on prints?  
Step 4  
Go to step 5.  
The problem is solved.  
a Reinstall the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
2 Install the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do streaked vertical lines appear on prints?  
Step 5  
Contact customer  
k.com or your service  
representative.  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Do streaked vertical lines appear on prints?  
Toner fog or background shading appears on prints  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
ABCDE  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
Reinstall the imaging unit.  
a Remove, and then install the imaging unit.  
b Resend the print job.  
Does fog or shading appear on prints?  
Step 2  
Contact customer  
k.com or your service  
representative.  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Does fog or shading appear on prints?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
217  
Toner rubs off  
Leading edge  
ABC  
DEF  
Trailing edge  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Specify the paper type,  
texture, and weight  
from the tray settings  
to match the paper  
loaded in the tray.  
From the Paper menu on the printer control panel, check the paper type,  
texture, and weight.  
Do the paper type, texture, and weight match the paper loaded in the  
tray?  
Step 2  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Resend the print job.  
Does the toner still rub off?  
Toner specks appear on prints  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Do toner specks appear on prints?  
Transparency print quality is poor  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Set the paper type to  
Transparency.  
From the printer control panel, set the paper type in the Paper menu to  
match the paper loaded in the tray.  
Is the paper type for the tray set to Transparency?  
Step 2  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
a Check if you are using a recommended type of transparency.  
b Resend the print job.  
Is the print quality still poor?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
218  
Uneven print density  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Is the print density uneven?  
Vertical voids appear on prints  
Leading edge  
Trailing edge  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
a Make sure your software program is using a correct fill pattern.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do vertical voids appear on prints?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
The problem is solved.  
The problem is solved.  
a From the printer control panel, set the paper type and weight in the  
Paper menu to match the paper loaded in the tray.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do vertical voids appear on prints?  
Step 3  
Check if you are using a recommended type of paper.  
a Load the specified tray or feeder with a recommended type of paper.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do vertical voids appear on prints?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
219  
Action  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved.  
Step 4  
Go to step 5.  
a Redistribute the toner in the imaging unit.  
1 Remove the toner cartridge, and then the imaging unit.  
2 Firmly shake the imaging unit.  
Warning—Potential Damage: Do not expose the imaging unit to  
direct light for more than 10 minutes. Extended exposure to  
light may cause print quality problems.  
3 Reinstall the imaging unit, and then the cartridge.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do vertical voids appear on prints?  
Step 5  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Replace the imaging unit, and then resend the print job.  
Do vertical voids appear on prints?  
Solving copy problems  
Copier does not respond  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Cleartheerrororstatus Go to step 2.  
message.  
Check if an error or status message appears on the display.  
Does an error or status message appear?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Connect the power  
cord to the printer and  
a properly grounded  
electrical outlet.  
Check if the power cord is plugged into the printer and a properly  
grounded electrical outlet.  
Is the power cord plugged into the printer and a properly grounded  
electrical outlet?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Turn off the printer, then wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn it back  
on.  
Did Performing Self Testand Readyappear?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
220  
Scanner unit does not close  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Check if there are no obstructions between the scanner unit and the  
printer.  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Lift the scanner unit.  
b Remove any obstruction that keeps the scanner unit open.  
c Lower the scanner unit.  
Did the scanner unit close properly?  
Poor copy quality  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Cleartheerrororstatus Go to step 2.  
message.  
Check if an error or status message appears on the display.  
Does an error or status message appear?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
Increase the scan  
resolution setting for a  
higherquality output.  
Check the quality of the original document.  
Is the quality of the original document satisfactory?  
Step 3  
If dark marks appear on prints, then clean the scanner glass and the ADF  
glass using a clean, lint-free cloth dampened with water.  
Is the scanner glass clean?  
Step 4  
Go to step 5.  
Send a print job, and then check for print quality problems.  
a From the General Settings menu, adjust the EcoMode settings.  
b From the Copy menu, adjust the Darkness setting.  
c If the print remains faded, then replace the toner cartridge.  
Is the print quality satisfactory?  
Step 5  
Go to step 6.  
Place the document or  
photo facedown on the  
scanner glass in the  
upper left corner.  
Check the placement of the document or photo.  
Make sure the document or photo is loaded facedown on the scanner  
glass in the upper left corner.  
Is the document or photo loaded correctly?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
221  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 6  
Go to step 7.  
Change the Content  
Type and Content  
Source settings to  
match the document  
being scanned.  
Check the copy settings.  
From the Copy screen, check if the Content Type and Content Source  
settings are correct for the document being scanned.  
Are the Content Type and Content Source settings correct for the  
document being scanned?  
Step 7  
Go to step 8.  
The problem is solved.  
The problem is solved.  
The problem is solved.  
Check for patterns on print.  
a From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
Copy > Sharpness > select a lower setting  
Note: Make sure no scaling is being selected.  
b Resend the copy job.  
Do patterns appear on prints?  
Step 8  
Go to step 9.  
Check for missing or faded text on prints.  
a From the Copy screen, adjust the settings of the following:  
Sharpness—Increase the sharpness setting.  
Contrast—Increase the contrast setting.  
b Resend the copy job.  
Do prints have missing or faded text?  
Step 9  
Contact customer  
Check for washedout or overexposed output.  
a From the Copy screen, adjust the settings of the following:  
Background Removal—Reduce the current setting.  
Darkness—Increase the current setting.  
b Resend the copy job.  
Do pages show washedout or overexposed prints?  
Partial document or photo copies  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Place the document or  
photo facedown on the  
scanner glass in the  
upper left corner.  
Check the placement of the document or photo.  
Make sure the document or photo is loaded facedown on the scanner  
glass in the upper left corner.  
Is the document or photo loaded correctly?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
222  
Action  
Step 2  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 3.  
Change the paper size  
setting to match the  
paper loaded in the  
tray, or load the tray  
with paper that  
matches the paper size  
setting.  
Check if the paper size setting matches the size of the paper loaded in the  
tray.  
From the Paper menu on the printer control panel, check the Paper  
Size setting.  
Does the paper size setting match the size of the paper loaded in the tray.  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Specify the paper size. Depending on your operating system, specify  
the paper size in Printing Preferences or the Print dialog.  
b Resend the print job.  
Do copies print properly?  
Solving fax problems  
Fax function is not set up  
Before completing these instructions for network printers, check if the fax cables are connected.  
Note: The indicator light blinks red until you set up fax.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
223  
Action  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a From the printer control panel, navigate to:  
> Settings >  
> General Settings >  
> Run initial setup >  
>
b Turn off the printer, and then turn it back on.  
The “Select your language” screen appears on the printer display.  
c Select a language, and then press  
d Select a country or region, and then press  
e Select a time zone, and then press  
.
.
.
f Press the up or down arrow button to scroll to Fax, and then press  
.
Is the fax function set up?  
Caller ID is not shown  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Contact your telephone company to check if your telephone line is  
subscribed to the caller ID service.  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Notes:  
If your region supports multiple caller ID patterns, then you may  
have to change the default setting. There are two settings  
available: FSK (pattern 1) and DTMF (pattern 2).  
The availability of these settings in the Fax menu depends on  
whether your country or region supports multiple caller ID  
patterns.  
Contact your telephone company to determine which pattern or  
switch setting to use.  
Does the caller ID appear?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
224  
Cannot send or receive a fax  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Cleartheerrororstatus Go to step 2.  
message.  
Check if an error or status message appears on the display.  
Is there an error or status message on the display?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
Connect the power  
cord to the printer and  
a properly grounded  
electrical outlet.  
Check if the power cord is plugged into the printer and a properly  
grounded electrical outlet.  
Is the power cord plugged into the printer and a properly grounded  
electrical outlet?  
Step 3  
Turn on the printer,  
and then wait until  
Readyappears on the  
display.  
Check the power.  
Check if the printer is plugged in and turned on, and if Readyappears  
on the display.  
Is the printer turned on, and does Readyappear on the display?  
Step 4  
Go to step 5.  
Securely connect the  
cables.  
Check the printer connections.  
If applicable, check if the cable connections for the following  
equipment are secure:  
Telephone  
Handset  
Answering machine  
Are the cable connections secure?  
Step 5  
The problem is solved. Go to step 6.  
a Check the telephone wall jack.  
1 Plug the telephone cable into the wall jack.  
2 Listen for a dial tone.  
3 If you do not hear a dial tone, then plug a different telephone cable  
into the wall jack.  
4 If you still do not hear a dial tone, then plug the telephone cable  
into a different wall jack.  
5 If you hear a dial tone, then connect the printer to that wall jack.  
b Try sending or receiving a fax.  
Can you send or receive a fax?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
225  
Action  
Step 6  
Yes  
No  
Go to step 7.  
Connect the printer to  
an analog phone  
service or the correct  
digital connector.  
Check if the printer is connected to an analog phone service or the correct  
digital connector.  
The fax modem is an analog device. Certain devices can be connected  
to the printer so that digital telephone services can be used.  
If you are using an ISDN telephone service, then connect the  
printer to an analog telephone port (an R-interface port) on an  
ISDN terminal adapter. For more information and to request an R-  
interface port, contact your ISDN provider.  
If you are using DSL, then connect to a DSL filter or router that will  
support analog use. For more information, contact your DSL  
provider.  
If you are using a PBX telephone service, then make sure you are  
connectingto an analog connectionon thePBX. If noneexists, then  
consider installing an analog telephone line for the fax machine.  
Is the printer connected to an analog phone service or the correct digital  
connector?  
Step 7  
Go to step 8.  
Try calling the fax  
number to make  
sure that it is  
Check for a dial tone.  
working properly.  
Did you hear a dial tone?  
If the telephone  
line is being used by  
another device,  
then wait until the  
other device is  
finished before  
sending a fax.  
If you are using the  
On Hook Dial  
feature, then turn  
up the volume to  
check if you hear a  
dial tone.  
Step 8  
The problem is solved. Go to step 9.  
Temporarily disconnect other equipment (such as answering machines,  
computers with modems, or telephone line splitters) between the printer  
and the telephone line, and then try sending or receiving a fax.  
Can you send or receive a fax?  
Step 9  
The problem is solved. Go to step 10.  
a Temporarily disable call waiting. Contact your telephone company to  
obtain the keypad sequence for temporarily disabling call waiting.  
b Try sending or receiving a fax.  
Can you send or receive a fax?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Troubleshooting  
226  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 10  
The problem is solved. Go to step 11.  
a Temporarily disable voice mail service. For more information, contact  
your telephone company.  
Note: If you want to use both voice mail and the printer, then  
consider adding a second telephone line for the printer.  
b Try sending or receiving a fax.  
Can you send or receive a fax?  
Step 11  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Scan the original document one page at a time.  
a Dial the fax number.  
b Scan the document one page at a time.  
Can you send or receive a fax?  
Can send but not receive faxes  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
Check the tray or feeder.  
If empty, then load paper in the tray or feeder.  
Can you receive faxes?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
Check the ring count delay settings.  
a Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the  
address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the  
Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four sets of  
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to  
load the Web page correctly.  
b Click Settings > Fax Settings > Analog Fax Setup.  
c In the “Rings to Answer” field, enter the number of times you want  
the phone to ring before the printer answers.  
d Click Submit.  
Can you receive faxes?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
227  
Action  
Step 3  
Yes  
No  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Replace the toner cartridge. For more information, see the instruction  
sheet that came with the supply.  
Can you receive faxes?  
Can receive but not send faxes  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
Check if the printer is in Fax mode.  
From the printer control panel, press Fax to put the printer in fax  
mode, and then resend the fax job.  
Can you send faxes?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
a Load the original document faceup, short edge first into the ADF tray  
or facedown on the scanner glass in the upper left corner.  
Notes:  
Do not load postcards, photos, small items, transparencies,  
photo paper, or thin media (such as magazine clippings) into  
the ADF tray. Place these items on the scanner glass.  
The ADF indicator light comes on when the paper is loaded  
properly.  
b Resend the fax job.  
Can you send faxes?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
a Check if the shortcut number is configured for the number that you  
want to dial.  
Note: As an alternative, you can dial the telephone number  
manually.  
b Resend the fax job.  
Can you send faxes?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
228  
Received fax has poor print quality  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
Ask the person who sent you the fax to:  
a Check if the quality of the original document is satisfactory.  
b Increase the fax scan resolution, if possible.  
c Resend the fax. There may have been a problem with the quality of  
the telephone line connection.  
Is the fax print quality satisfactory?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
Decrease the incoming fax transmission speed.  
a Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address in the  
address field.  
Notes:  
View the printer IP address in the TCP/IP section in the  
Network/Ports menu. The IP address appears as four sets of  
numbers separated by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
If you are using a proxy server, then temporarily disable it to  
load the Web page correctly.  
b Click Settings > Fax Settings > Analog Fax Setup.  
c In the Max Speed menu, click one of the following:  
2400  
4800  
9600  
14400  
33600  
d Click Submit.  
e Resend the fax.  
Is the fax print quality satisfactory?  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Replace the toner cartridge.  
When Cartridge low [88.xy]appears, replace the cartridge,  
and then resend the fax.  
Is the fax print quality satisfactory?  
Solving scanner problems  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
229  
The scanner does not respond  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Turn on the printer.  
Check if the printer is turned on.  
Is the printer turned on?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
Connect the printer  
cable securely to the  
printer and the  
computer, print server,  
option, or other  
network device.  
Check if the printer cable is securely attached to the printer and the  
computer, print server, option, or other network device.  
Is the printer cable securely attached to the printer and the computer,  
print server, option, or other network device?  
Step 3  
Connect the power  
cord to the printer and  
a properly grounded  
electrical outlet.  
Check if the power cord is plugged into the printer and a properly  
grounded electrical outlet.  
Is the power cord plugged into the printer and a properly grounded  
electrical outlet?  
Step 4  
Turn on the switch or Go to step 5.  
reset the breaker.  
Check if the electrical outlet is turned off by a switch or breaker.  
Is the electrical outlet turned off by a switch or breaker?  
Step 5  
Connect the printer  
power cord directly to  
a properly grounded  
electrical outlet.  
Go to step 6.  
Go to step 7.  
Check if the printer is plugged into any surge protectors, uninterruptible  
power supplies, or extension cords.  
Is the printer plugged into any surge protectors, uninterruptible power  
supplies, or extension cords?  
Step 6  
Unplug the other  
electrical equipment  
and turn on the printer.  
If the printer does not  
work, then reconnect  
the other electrical  
equipment and then go  
to step 6.  
Check other electrical equipment plugged into the outlet.  
Are the other electrical equipment working?  
Step 7  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
Turn off the printer, then wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the  
printer back on.  
Are the printer and scanner working?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
230  
Scan job was not successful  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
Connect the cables  
properly.  
Check the cable connections.  
Make sure the Ethernet or USB cable is securely connected to the  
computer and the printer.  
Are the cables securely connected?  
Step 2  
Change the file name. Go to step 3.  
Check if the file name is already in use.  
Is the file name already in use?  
Step 3  
Close the file you are Go to step 4.  
scanning.  
Check if the document or photo you want to scan is open in another  
application or being used by another user.  
Is the file you want to scan open by another application or user?  
Step 4  
Contact customer  
Selectthe Appendtime  
stamp or Overwrite  
existing file check box  
in the destination  
CheckifeithertheAppendtimestamportheOverwriteexisting file check  
box is selected in the destination configuration settings.  
configuration settings.  
Is the Append time stamp or Overwrite existing file check box selected  
in the destination configuration settings?  
Scanner unit does not close  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Check if there are obstructions in the scanner unit.  
a Lift the scanner unit.  
The problem is solved. Contact customer  
b Remove any obstruction keeping the scanner unit open.  
c Lower the scanner unit.  
Did the scanner unit close correctly?  
Scanning takes too long or freezes the computer  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Go to step 2.  
The problem is solved.  
Check if other applications are interfering with the scan.  
Close all applications that are not being used.  
Does scanning still take too long or freeze the computer?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Troubleshooting  
231  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 2  
Contact customer  
The problem is solved.  
Select a lower scan resolution.  
Does scanning still take too long or freeze the computer?  
Poor scanned image quality  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
Clear the error  
message.  
Go to step 2.  
Check if an error message appears on the display.  
Is there an error message on the printer display?  
Step 2  
Go to step 3.  
Go to step 4.  
Increase the scan  
resolutionsettingsfor a  
higherquality output.  
Check the quality of the original document.  
Is the quality of the original document satisfactory?  
Step 3  
Clean the scanner glass and the ADF glass using a clean, lintfree cloth  
dampened with water.  
Is the scanner glass clean?  
Step 4  
Go to step 5.  
Go to step 6.  
Place the document or  
photo facedown on the  
scanner glass in the  
upper left corner.  
Check the placement of the document or photo.  
Make sure the document or photo is loaded facedown on the scanner  
glass in the upper left corner.  
Is the document or photo loaded correctly?  
Step 5  
Send a print job, and then check for print quality problems.  
From the General Settings menu, adjust the EcoMode settings.  
From the Copy menu, adjust the Darkness setting.  
When the print becomes faded, replace the toner cartridge.  
Is the print quality satisfactory?  
Step 6  
Go to step 7.  
Change the Content  
Type and Content  
Source settings to  
match the document  
being scanned.  
Check the scan settings.  
FromtheScanscreen, makesuretheContentTypeandContentSource  
settings are correct for the document being scanned.  
Are the Content Type and Content Source settings correct for the  
document being scanned?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
232  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 7  
Problem solved.  
Contact customer  
Increase the scan resolution settings for a higherquality output.  
Did the increased resolution produce a higherquality output?  
Partial document or photo scans  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Check the placement of the document or photo.  
Contact customer  
Load the document or  
photo facedown on the  
scanner glass in the  
upper left corner.  
Make sure the document or photo is loaded facedown on the scanner  
glass in the upper left corner.  
Is the document or photo loaded correctly?  
Embedded Web Server does not open  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 1  
The problem is solved. Go to step 2.  
a Turn on the printer.  
b Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address.  
c Press Enter.  
Does the Embedded Web Server open?  
Step 2  
The problem is solved. Go to step 3.  
Make sure the printer IP address is correct.  
a View the printer IP address:  
From the TCP/IP section in the Network/Ports menu  
By printing a network setup page or menu settings page, and then  
finding the TCP/IP section  
Note: An IP address appears as four sets of numbers separated  
by periods, such as 123.123.123.123.  
b Open a Web browser, and then type the IP address.  
Note: Depending on the network settings, you may need to type  
https://” instead of “http://” before the printer IP address  
to access the Embedded Web Server.  
c Press Enter.  
Does the Embedded Web Server open?  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Troubleshooting  
233  
Action  
Yes  
No  
Step 3  
The problem is solved. Go to step 4.  
Check if the network is working.  
a Print a network setup page.  
b Check the first section of the network setup page and confirm that the  
status is Connected.  
Note: If the status is Not Connected, then the connection may be  
intermittent, or the network cable may be defective. Contact your  
system support person for a solution, and then print another  
network setup page.  
c Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address.  
d Press Enter.  
Does the Embedded Web Server open?  
Step 4  
The problem is solved. Go to step 5.  
Check if the cable connections to the printer and print server are secure.  
a Connect the cables properly. For more information, see the setup  
documentation that came with the printer.  
b Open a Web browser, and then type the printer IP address.  
c Press Enter.  
Does the Embedded Web Server open?  
Step 5  
The problem is solved. Contact your system  
support person.  
Temporarily disable the Web proxy servers.  
Proxy servers may block or restrict you from accessing certain Web  
sites including the Embedded Web Server.  
Does the Embedded Web Server open?  
Contacting customer support  
When you contactcustomer support, you willneed tobeable todescribe theproblem youareexperiencing, themessage  
on the printer display, and the troubleshooting steps you have already taken to find a solution.  
You need to know your printer model type and serial number. For more information, see the label at the back of the  
printer. The serial number is also listed on the menu settings page.  
Lexmark has various ways to help you solve your printing problem. Visit the Lexmark Web site at  
http://support.lexmark.com, and then select one of the following:  
Tech Library You can browse our library of manuals, support documentation, drivers, and other downloads to help you  
solve common problems.  
E-mail  
You can send an e-mail to the Lexmark team, describing your problem. A service representative will respond  
and provide you with information to solve your problem.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Troubleshooting  
234  
Live chat  
You can chat directly with a service representative. They can work with you to solve your printer problem or  
provide assistance through Assisted Service where the service representative can remotely connect to your  
computer through the Internet to troubleshoot problems, install updates, or complete other tasks to help  
you successfully use your Lexmark product.  
Telephone support is also available. In the U.S. or Canada, call 1-800-539-6275. For other countries or regions, visit  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notices  
235  
Notices  
Product information  
Product name:  
Lexmark XM1135  
Machine type:  
7015  
Model(s):  
279  
Edition notice  
March 2014  
The following paragraph does not apply to any country where such provisions are inconsistent with local law:  
LEXMARK INTERNATIONAL, INC., PROVIDES THIS PUBLICATION “AS IS” WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER  
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS  
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. Some states do not allow disclaimer of express or implied warranties in certain  
transactions; therefore, this statement may not apply to you.  
This publication could include technical inaccuracies or typographical errors. Changes are periodically made to the  
information herein; these changes will be incorporated in later editions. Improvements or changes in the products or  
the programs described may be made at any time.  
References in this publication to products, programs, or services do not imply that the manufacturer intends to make  
these available in all countries in which it operates. Any reference to a product, program, or service is not intended to  
state or imply that only that product, program, or service may be used. Any functionally equivalent product, program,  
or service that does not infringe any existing intellectual property right may be used instead. Evaluation and verification  
of operation in conjunction with other products, programs, or services, except those expressly designated by the  
manufacturer, are the user’s responsibility.  
For Lexmark technical support, visit http://support.lexmark.com.  
For information on supplies and downloads, visit www.lexmark.com.  
© 2014 Lexmark International, Inc.  
All rights reserved.  
GOVERNMENT END USERS  
The Software Program and any related documentation are "Commercial Items," as that term is defined in 48 C.F.R.  
2.101, "Computer Software" and "Commercial Computer Software Documentation," as such terms are used in 48 C.F.R.  
12.212or48C.F.R.227.7202,asapplicable. Consistentwith48C.F.R. 12.212or48C.F.R. 227.7202-1through227.7207-4,  
as applicable, the Commercial Computer Software and Commercial Software Documentation are licensed to the U.S.  
Government end users (a) only as Commercial Items and (b) with only those rights as are granted to all other end users  
pursuant to the terms and conditions herein.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Notices  
236  
Licensing notices  
All licensing notices associated with this product can be viewed from the root directory of the documentation CD.  
Trademarks  
Lexmark, Lexmark with diamond design, and MarkVision are trademarks of Lexmark International, Inc., registered in  
the United States and/or other countries.  
PrintCryption is a trademark of Lexmark International, Inc.  
Mac and the Mac logo are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.  
PCL® is a registered trademark of the Hewlett-Packard Company. PCL is Hewlett-Packard Company’s designation of a  
set of printer commands (language) and functions included in its printer products. This printer is intended to be  
compatible with the PCL language. This means the printer recognizes PCL commands used in various application  
programs, and that the printer emulates the functions corresponding to the commands.  
The following terms are trademarks or registered trademarks of these companies:  
Albertus  
The Monotype Corporation plc  
Monsieur Marcel OLIVE  
Antique Olive  
Apple-Chancery  
Arial  
Apple Computer, Inc.  
The Monotype Corporation plc  
CG Times  
Based on Times New Roman under license from The Monotype Corporation plc, is a product of  
Agfa Corporation  
Chicago  
Clarendon  
Eurostile  
Geneva  
Apple Computer, Inc.  
Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries  
Nebiolo  
Apple Computer, Inc.  
GillSans  
Helvetica  
Hoefler  
The Monotype Corporation plc  
Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries  
Jonathan Hoefler Type Foundry  
ITC Avant Garde Gothic International Typeface Corporation  
ITC Bookman  
ITC Mona Lisa  
ITC Zapf Chancery  
Joanna  
International Typeface Corporation  
International Typeface Corporation  
International Typeface Corporation  
The Monotype Corporation plc  
Arthur Baker  
Marigold  
Monaco  
Apple Computer, Inc.  
New York  
Oxford  
Apple Computer, Inc.  
Arthur Baker  
Palatino  
Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
237  
Stempel Garamond  
Taffy  
Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries  
Agfa Corporation  
Times New Roman  
Univers  
The Monotype Corporation plc  
Linotype-Hell AG and/or its subsidiaries  
All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners.  
AirPrint and the AirPrint logo are trademarks of Apple, Inc.  
Federal Communications Commission (FCC) compliance information statement  
This product has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the  
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause harmful interference,  
and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
The FCC Class B limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment  
is operated in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and,  
if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications.  
However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause  
harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on,  
the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures:  
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.  
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.  
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected.  
Consult your point of purchase or service representative for additional suggestions.  
The manufacturer is not responsible for radio or television interference caused by using other than recommended  
cables or by unauthorized changes or modifications to this equipment. Unauthorized changes or modifications could  
void the user's authority to operate this equipment.  
Note: To assure compliance with FCC regulations on electromagnetic interference for a Class B computing device,  
use a properly shielded and grounded cable such as Lexmark part number 1021231 for parallel attach or 1021294 for  
USB attach. Use of a substitute cable not properly shielded and grounded may result in a violation of FCC  
regulations.  
Any questions regarding this compliance information statement should be directed to:  
Director of Lexmark Technology & Services  
Lexmark International, Inc.  
740 West New Circle Road  
Lexington, KY 40550  
(859) 232–3000  
Noise emission levels  
The following measurements were made in accordance with ISO 7779 and reported in conformance with ISO 9296.  
Note: Some modes may not apply to your product.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Notices  
238  
1-meter average sound pressure, dBA  
Printing  
Scanning  
Copying  
Ready  
52  
45  
54  
N/A  
Values are subject to change. See www.lexmark.com for current values.  
Temperature information  
Ambient operating temperature  
Shipping temperature  
15.6 to 32.2°C (60 to 90°F)  
-40 to 43.3°C (-40 to 110°F)  
Storage temperature and relative humidity  
1 to 35°C (34 to 95°F)  
8 to 80% RH  
Waste from Electrical and Electronic Equipment (WEEE) directive  
The WEEE logo signifies specific recycling programs and procedures for electronic products in countries of the European  
Union. We encourage the recycling of our products.  
If you have further questions about recycling options, visit the Lexmark Web site at www.lexmark.com for your local  
sales office phone number.  
India E-Waste notice  
This product complies with the India E-Waste (Management and Handling) Rules, 2011, which prohibit use of lead,  
mercury, hexavalent chromium, polybrominated biphenyls, or polybrominated diphenyl ethers in concentrations  
exceeding 0.1by weight and 0.01% by weight for cadmium, except for the exemption set in Schedule II of the Rules.  
Product disposal  
Do not dispose of the printer or supplies in the same manner as normal household waste. Consult your local authorities  
for disposal and recycling options.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
239  
Static sensitivity notice  
This symbol identifies static-sensitive parts. Do not touch in the areas near these symbols without first touching the  
metal frame of the printer.  
ENERGY STAR  
Any Lexmark product bearing the ENERGY STAR emblem on the product or on a start-up screen is certified to comply  
with Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) ENERGY STAR requirements as configured when shipped by Lexmark.  
Laser notice  
The printer is certified in the U.S. to conform to the requirements of DHHS 21 CFR, Chapter I, Subchapter J for Class I  
(1) laser products, and elsewhere is certified as a Class I laser product conforming to the requirements of IEC 60825-1.  
Class I laser products are not considered to be hazardous. The printer contains internally a Class IIIb (3b) laser that is  
nominally a 7 milliwatt gallium arsenide laser operating in the wavelength of 655-675 nanometers. The laser system  
and printer are designed so there is never any human access to laser radiation above a Class I level during normal  
operation, user maintenance, or prescribed service condition.  
Laser advisory label  
A laser notice label may be affixed to this printer as shown:  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
240  
DANGER - Invisible laser radiation when cartridges are removed and interlock defeated. Avoid exposure to laser beam.  
PERIGO - Radiação a laser invisível será liberada se os cartuchos forem removidos e o lacre rompido. Evite a exposição aos feixes de laser.  
Opasnost - Nevidljivo lasersko zračenje kada su kasete uklonjene i poništena sigurnosna veza. Izbjegavati izlaganje zracima.  
NEBEZPEČÍ - Když jsou vyjmuty kazety a je odblokována pojistka, ze zařízení je vysíláno neviditelné laserové záření. Nevystavujte se působení laserového paprsku.  
FARE - Usynlig laserstråling, når patroner fjernes, og spærreanordningen er slået fra. Undgå at blive udsat for laserstrålen.  
GEVAAR - Onzichtbare laserstraling wanneer cartridges worden verwijderd en een vergrendeling wordt genegeerd. Voorkom blootstelling aan de laser.  
DANGER - Rayonnements laser invisibles lors du retrait des cartouches et du déverrouillage des loquets. Eviter toute exposition au rayon laser.  
VAARA - Näkymätöntä lasersäteilyä on varottava, kun värikasetit on poistettu ja lukitus on auki. Vältä lasersäteelle altistumista.  
GEFAHR - Unsichtbare Laserstrahlung beim Herausnehmen von Druckkassetten und offener Sicherheitssperre. Laserstrahl meiden.  
ΚΙΝΔΥΝΟΣ - Έκλυση αόρατης ακτινοβολίας laser κατά την αφαίρεση των κασετών και την απασφάλιση της μανδάλωσης. Αποφεύγετε την έκθεση στην ακτινοβολία laser.  
VESZÉLY – Nem látható lézersugárzás fordulhat elő a patronok eltávolításakor és a zárószerkezet felbontásakor. Kerülje a lézersugárnak való kitettséget.  
PERICOLO - Emissione di radiazioni laser invisibili durante la rimozione delle cartucce e del blocco. Evitare l´esposizione al raggio laser.  
FARE – Usynlig laserstråling når kassettene tas ut og sperren er satt ut av spill. Unngå eksponering for laserstrålen.  
NIEBEZPIECZEŃSTWO - niewidzialne promieniowanie laserowe podczas usuwania kaset i blokady. Należy unikać naświetlenia promieniem lasera.  
ОПАСНО! Невидимое лазерное излучение при извлеченных картриджах и снятии блокировки. Избегайте воздействия лазерных лучей.  
Pozor – Nebezpečenstvo neviditeľného laserového žiarenia pri odobratých kazetách a odblokovanej poistke. Nevystavujte sa lúčom.  
PELIGRO: Se producen radiaciones láser invisibles al extraer los cartuchos con el interbloqueo desactivado. Evite la exposición al haz de láser.  
FARA – Osynlig laserstrålning när patroner tas ur och spärrmekanismen är upphävd. Undvik exponering för laserstrålen.  
- 当移除碳粉盒及互失效生看不的激光射,避免暴露在激光光束下。  
危險 - 移除碳粉匣與安全連續開關失效時會生看不見的雷射輻射。請避免曝露在雷射光束下。  
危険 - カートリッジが取り外され、内部ロックが無効になると、見えないレーザー光が放射されます。 このレーザー光に当たらないようにしてください。  
Power consumption  
Product power consumption  
The following table documents the power consumption characteristics of the product.  
Note: Some modes may not apply to your product.  
Mode  
Description  
Power consumption  
(Watts)  
Printing  
Copy  
The product is generating hardcopy output from electronic inputs.  
The product is generating hardcopy output from hardcopy original documents.  
The product is scanning hardcopy documents.  
520  
540  
30  
Scan  
Ready  
The product is waiting for a print job.  
12  
Sleep Mode The product is in a highlevel energysaving mode.  
5
Hibernate The product is in a lowlevel energysaving mode.  
0.5  
Off  
The product is plugged into an electrical outlet, but the power switch is turned off. 0  
The power consumption levels listed in the previous table represent time-averaged measurements. Instantaneous  
power draws may be substantially higher than the average.  
Values are subject to change. See www.lexmark.com for current values.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Notices  
241  
Sleep Mode  
This product is designed with an energy-saving mode called Sleep Mode. The Sleep Mode saves energy by lowering  
power consumption during extended periods of inactivity. The Sleep Mode is automatically engaged after this product  
is not used for a specified period of time, called the Sleep Mode Timeout.  
Factory default Sleep Mode Timeout for this product (in minutes):  
20  
By using the configuration menus, the Sleep Mode Timeout can be modified between 1 minute and 120 minutes. Setting  
the Sleep ModeTimeout toa low value reduces energy consumption, but mayincrease theresponse timeof the product.  
Setting the Sleep Mode Timeout to a high value maintains a fast response, but uses more energy.  
Hibernate Mode  
This product is designed with an ultralow power operating mode called Hibernate mode. When operating in Hibernate  
Mode, all other systems and devices are powered down safely.  
The Hibernate mode can be entered in any of the following methods:  
Using the Hibernate Timeout  
Using the Schedule Power modes  
Using the Sleep/Hibernate button  
Factory default Hibernate Timeout for this product in all countries or regions  
3 days  
The amount of time the printer waits after a job is printed before it enters Hibernate mode can be modified between  
one hour and one month.  
Off mode  
If this product has an off mode which still consumes a small amount of power, then to completely stop product power  
consumption, disconnect the power supply cord from the electrical outlet.  
Total energy usage  
It is sometimes helpful to calculate the total product energy usage. Since power consumption claims are provided in  
power units of Watts, the power consumption should be multiplied by the time the product spends in each mode in  
order to calculate energy usage. The total product energy usage is the sum of each mode's energy usage.  
Industry Canada compliance statement  
This Class B digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian Interference-Causing Equipment Standard  
ICES-003.  
Avis de conformité aux normes de l’industrie du Canada  
Cet appareil numérique de classe B est conforme aux exigences de la norme canadienne relative aux équipements  
pouvant causer des interférences NMB-003.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Notices  
242  
日本の VCCI 規定  
製品にこのマークが表示されている場合、次の要件を満たしています。  
この装置は、クラス B 情報技術装置です。この装置は、家庭環境で使用することを目的としていますが、この  
装置がラジオやテレビジョン受信機に近接して使用されると、受信障害を引き起こすことがあります。  
取扱説明書に従って正しい取り扱いをしてください。  
VCCI-B  
European Community (EC) directives conformity  
This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives 2004/108/EC, 2006/95/EC,  
2009/125/EC, and 2011/65/EU on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of the Member States relating to  
electromagnetic compatibility, safety of electrical equipment designed for use within certain voltage limits, the  
ecodesign of energy-related products, and on the restrictions of use of certain hazardous substances in electrical and  
electronic equipment.  
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY, 40550 USA.  
The authorized representative is: Lexmark International Technology Hungária Kft., 8 Lechner Ödön fasor, Millennium  
Tower III, 1095 Budapest HUNGARY. A declaration of conformity to the requirements of the Directives is available upon  
request from the Authorized Representative.  
This product satisfies the Class B limits of EN 55022 and safety requirements of EN 609501.  
Regulatory notices for telecommunication terminal equipment  
This section contains regulatory information pertaining to products that contain telecommunication terminal  
equipment such as facsimile.  
Notice to users of the US telephone network: FCC requirements  
This equipment complies with Part 68 of the FCC rules and the requirements adopted by the Administrative Council  
for Terminal Attachments (ACTA). On the back of this equipment is a label that contains, among other information, a  
product identifier in the format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX. If requested, this number must be provided to your telephone  
company.  
This equipment uses the RJ-11C Universal Service Order Code (USOC) jack.  
A plug and jack used to connect this equipment to the premises’ wiring and telephone network must comply with the  
applicable FCC Part 68 rules and requirements adopted by the ACTA. A compliant telephone cord and modular plug is  
provided with this product. It is designed to be connected to a compatible modular jack that is also compliant. See your  
setup documentation for more information.  
The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) is used to determine the number of devices that may be connected to a telephone  
line. Excessive RENs on a telephone line may result in the devices not ringing in response to an incoming call. In most  
but not all areas, the sum of RENs should not exceed five (5.0). To be certain of the number of devices that may be  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Notices  
243  
connected to a line, as determined by the total RENs, contact your local telephone company. For products approved  
after July 23, 2001, the REN for this product is part of the product identifier that has the format US:AAAEQ##TXXXX.  
The digits represented by ## are the REN without a decimal point (for example, 03 is a REN of 0.3). For earlier products,  
the REN is shown separately on the label.  
If this equipment causes harm to the telephone network, the telephone company will notify you in advance that  
temporary discontinuance of service may be required. If advance notice is not practical, the telephone company will  
notify the customer as soon as possible. You will also be advised of your right to file a complaint with the FCC.  
The telephone company may make changes in its facilities, equipment, operations or procedures that could affect the  
operation of this equipment. If this happens, the telephone company will provide advance notice in order for you to  
make necessary modifications to maintain uninterrupted service.  
If you experience trouble with this equipment, for repair or warranty information, contact Lexmark International, Inc.  
at www.lexmark.com or your Lexmark representative. If the equipment is causing harm to the telephone network, the  
telephone company may request that you disconnect the equipment until the problem is resolved.  
This equipment contains no user serviceable parts. For repair and warranty information, contact Lexmark International,  
Inc. See the previous paragraph for contact information.  
Connection to party line service is subject to state tariffs. Contact the state public utility commission, public service  
commission, or corporation commission for information.  
If your home has specially wired alarm equipment connected to the telephone line, ensure the installation of this  
equipment does not disable your alarm equipment. If you have questions about what will disable alarm equipment,  
consult your telephone company or a qualified installer.  
Telephone companies report that electrical surges, typically lightning transients, are very destructive to customer  
terminal equipment connected to AC power sources. This has been identified as a major nationwide problem. It is  
recommended that the customer install an appropriate AC surge arrestor in the AC outlet to which this device is  
connected. An appropriate AC surge arrestor is defined as one that is suitably rated, and certified by UL (Underwriter's  
Laboratories), another NRTL (Nationally Recognized Testing Laboratory), or a recognized safety certification body in  
the country/region of use. This is to avoid damage to the equipment caused by local lightning strikes and other electrical  
surges.  
The Telephone Consumer Protection Act of 1991 makes it unlawful for any person to use a computer or other electronic  
device, including fax machines, to send any message unless said message clearly contains in a margin at the top or  
bottom of each transmitted page or on the first page of the transmission, the date and time itis sent and an identification  
of the business or other entity, or other individual sending the message, and the telephone number of the sending  
machine or such business, other entity, or individual. (The telephone number provided may not be a 900 number or  
any other number for which charges exceed local or long-distance transmission charges.)  
See your user documentation in order to program this information into your fax machine.  
Notice to users of the Canadian telephone network  
This product meets the applicable Industry Canada technical specifications. The Ringer Equivalence Number (REN) is  
an indication of the maximum number of terminals allowed to be connected to a telephone interface. The terminus of  
an interface may consist of any combination of devices, subject only to the requirement that the sum of the RENs of  
all the devices does not exceed five. The modem REN is located on the rear of the equipment on the product labeling.  
Telephone companies report that electrical surges, typically lightning transients, are very destructive to customer  
terminal equipment connected to AC power sources. This has been identified as a major nationwide problem. It is  
recommended that the customer install an appropriate AC surge arrestor in the AC outlet to which this device is  
connected. An appropriate AC surge arrestor is defined as one that is suitably rated, and certified by UL (Underwriter’s  
Laboratories), another NRTL (Nationally Recognized Testing Laboratory), or a recognized safety certification body in  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
244  
the country/region of use. This is to avoid damage to the equipment caused by local lightning strikes and other electrical  
surges.  
This equipment uses CA11A telephone jacks.  
Avis réservé aux utilisateurs du réseau téléphonique du Canada  
Ce produit est conforme aux spécifications techniques d’Industrie Canada. Le numéro REN (ringer equivalence number :  
numéro d’équivalence de sonnerie) fournit une indication du nombre maximum de terminaux pouvant être connectés  
à l’interface téléphonique. En bout de ligne, le nombre d’appareils qui peuvent être connectés n’est pas directement  
limité, mais la somme des REN de ces appareils ne doit pas dépasser cinq. Le numéro REN du modem est indiqué sur  
l’étiquette produit située à l’arrière de l’équipement.  
Les compagnies de téléphone constatent que les surtensions électriques, en particulier celles dues à la foudre,  
entraînent d'importants dégâts sur les terminaux privés connectés à des sources d’alimentation CA. Il s’agit-là d’un  
problème majeur d’échelle nationale. En conséquence, il vous est recommandé de brancher un parasurtenseur dans  
la prise de courant à laquelle l’équipement est connecté. Utilisez un parasurtenseur répondant à des caractéristiques  
nominales satisfaisantes et certifié par le laboratoire d’assureurs UL (Underwriter’s Laboratories), un autre laboratoire  
agréé de type NRTL (Nationally Recognized Testing Laboratory) ou un organisme de certification agréé dans votre région  
ou pays. Ceci prévient tout endommagement de l’équipement causé par les orages et autres surtensions électriques.  
Cet équipement utilise des prises de téléphone CA11A.  
Notice to users of the New Zealand telephone network  
The following are special conditions for the Facsimile User Instructions. The grant of a telepermit for any item of terminal  
equipment indicates only that Telecom has accepted that the item complies with minimum conditions for connection  
to its network. It indicates no endorsement of the product by Telecom, nor does it provide any sort of warranty. Above  
all, it provides no assurance that any item will work correctly in all respects with another item of telepermitted  
equipment of a different make or model, nor does it imply that any product is compatible with all of Telecom's network  
services.  
This equipment shall not be set up to make automatic calls to the Telecom's 111 Emergency Service.  
This equipment may not provide for the effective hand-over of a call to another device connected to the same line.  
This equipment should not be used under any circumstances that may constitute a nuisance to other Telecom  
customers.  
Some parameters required for compliance with Telecom's telepermit requirements are dependent on the equipment  
associated with this device. The associated equipment shall be set to operate within the following limits for compliance  
to Telecom's specifications:  
There shall be no more than 10 call attempts to the same number within any 30 minute period for any single manual  
call initiation, and  
The equipment shall go on-hook for a period of not less than 30 seconds between the end of one attempt and the  
beginning of the next call attempt.  
The equipment shall be set to ensure that automatic calls to different numbers are spaced such that there is not  
less than 5 seconds between the end of one call attempt and the beginning of another.  
Japanese telecom notice  
The installed optional modem is in compliance with Japanese Telecommunication Law and has been Certified by JATE,  
with Certification Number A11-0160001.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
245  
Lexmark International, Inc.  
LEX-M03-002  
A11-0160001JP  
Using this product in Switzerland  
This product requires a Swiss billing tone filter (Lexmark part number 80D1877) to be installed on any line which receives  
metering pulses in Switzerland. The filter must be used, as metering pulses are present on all analog telephone lines  
in Switzerland.  
Utilisation de ce produit en Suisse  
Cet appareil nécessite l’utilisation d’un filtre de tonalité de facturation suisse (nº de référence Lexmark : 80D1877)  
devant être installé sur toute ligne recevant des impulsions de comptage en Suisse. Ce filtre doit être utilisé pour toute  
installation car ces impulsions existent sur toutes les lignes téléphoniques suisses.  
Verwendung dieses Produkts in der Schweiz  
Für dieses Produkt muss ein schweizerischer Billing Tone Filter zur Zählzeichenübertragung (Lexmark Teilenummer  
80D1877) für jede Leitung installiert werden, über die in der Schweiz Zeitsteuertakte übertragen werden. Die  
Verwendung des Filters ist obligatorisch, da in allen analogen Telefonleitungen in der Schweiz Zeitsteuertakte  
vorhanden sind.  
Uso del prodotto in Svizzera  
Questo prodotto richiede un filtro toni Billing svizzero, (codice Lexmark 80D1877) da installare su tutte le linee che  
ricevono impulsi remoti in Svizzera. È necessario utilizzare il filtro poiché gli impulsi remoti sono presenti su tutte le  
linee analogiche in Svizzera.  
Notice to Users in the European Union  
Products bearing the CE mark are in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives 2004/108/EC,  
2006/95/EC, 1999/5/EC, and 2009/125/EC on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of the Member States  
relating to electromagnetic compatibility, safety of electrical equipment designed for use within certain voltage limits,  
radio equipment and telecommunications terminal equipment and on the ecodesign of energyrelated products.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
246  
Compliance is indicated by the CE marking.  
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY, 40550 USA.  
The authorized representative is: Lexmark International Technology Hungária Kft., 8 Lechner Ödön fasor, Millennium  
Tower III, 1095 Budapest HUNGARY, A declaration of conformity to the requirements of the Directives is available upon  
request from the Authorized Representative.  
This product satisfies the Class B limits of EN 55022 and safety requirements of EN 609501.  
Refer to the table at the end of the Notices section for further compliance information.  
Regulatory notices for wireless products  
This section contains the following regulatory information pertaining to wireless products that contain transmitters,  
for example, but not limited to, wireless network cards or proximity card readers.  
Modular component notice  
Wirelessequipped models contain the following modular component(s):  
Lexmark Regulatory Type/Model LEX-M01-005; FCC ID:IYLLEXM01005; IC:2376A-M01005  
Exposure to radio frequency radiation  
The radiated output power of this device is far below the radio frequency exposure limits of the FCC and other regulatory  
agencies. A minimum separation of 20 cm (8 inches) must be maintained between the antenna and any persons for  
this device to satisfy the RF exposure requirements of the FCC and other regulatory agencies.  
Notice to users in Brazil  
Este equipamento opera em carater secundario, isto e, nao tem direito a protecao contra interferencia prejudicial,  
mesmo de estacoes do mesmo tipo, e nao pode causar interferencia a sistemas operando em carater primario.  
(Res.ANATEL 282/2001).  
Industry Canada (Canada)  
This device complies with Industry Canada specification RSS-210. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
(1) this device may not cause interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that  
may cause undesired operation of the device.  
This device has been designed to operate only with the antenna provided. Use of any other antenna is strictly prohibited  
per regulations of Industry Canada.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Notices  
247  
To prevent radio interference to the licensed service, this device is intended to be operated indoors and away from  
windows to provide maximum shielding. Equipment (or its transmit antenna) that is installed outdoors is subject to  
licensing.  
The installer of this radio equipment must ensure that the antenna is located or pointed such that it does not emit RF  
fields in excess of Health Canada limits for the general population; consult Safety Code 6, obtainable from Health  
Canada's Web site www.hc-sc.gc.ca/rpb.  
The term "IC:" before the certification/registration number only signifies that the Industry Canada technical  
specifications were met.  
Industry Canada (Canada)  
Cet appareil est conforme à la norme RSS-210 d'Industry Canada. Son fonctionnement est soumis aux deux conditions  
suivantes :  
(1) cet appareil ne doit pas provoquer d'interférences et (2) il doit accepter toute interférence reçue, y compris celles  
risquant d'altérer son fonctionnement.  
Cet appareil a été conçu pour fonctionner uniquement avec l'antenne fournie. L'utilisation de toute autre antenne est  
strictement interdite par la réglementation d'Industry Canada.  
En application des réglementations d'Industry Canada, l'utilisation d'une antenne de gain supérieur est strictement  
interdite.  
Pour empêcher toute interférence radio au service faisant l'objet d'une licence, cet appareil doit être utilisé à l'intérieur  
et loin des fenêtres afin de garantir une protection optimale.  
Si le matériel (ou son antenne d'émission) est installé à l'extérieur, il doit faire l'objet d'une licence.  
L'installateur de cet équipement radio doit veiller à ce que l'antenne soit implantée et dirigée de manière à n'émettre  
aucun champ HF dépassant les limites fixées pour l'ensemble de la population par Santé Canada. Reportez-vous au  
Code de sécurité 6 que vous pouvez consulter sur le site Web de Santé Canada www.hc-sc.gc.ca/rpb.  
Le terme « IC » précédant le numéro de d'accréditation/inscription signifie simplement que le produit est conforme  
aux spécifications techniques d'Industry Canada.  
Taiwan NCC RF notice statement  
NCC 型式認證設備注意事項  
台灣低功率射頻電機設備之使用注意事項  
依據低功率電波輻射性電機管理辦法  
第十二條 經型式認證合格之低功率射頻電機,非經許可,公司、商號或使用者均不得擅自變更頻率、加大功  
率或變更原設計之特性及功能。  
第十四條 低功率射頻電機之使用不得影響飛航安全及干擾合法通信;經發現有干擾現象時,應立即停用,並  
改善至無干擾時方得繼續使用。前項合法通信,指依電信法規定作業之無線電通信。低功率射頻電機須忍受合  
法通信或工業、科學及醫療用電波輻射性電機設備之干擾。  
5.25 ~ 5.35 秭赫頻帶操作之無線資訊傳輸設備,限於室使用。  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
248  
Notice to users in the European Union  
This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives 2004/108/EC, 2006/95/EC,  
1999/5/EC, 2009/125/EC, and 2011/65/EU on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of the Member States  
relating to electromagnetic compatibility, safety of electrical equipment designed for use within certain voltage limits,  
radio equipment and telecommunications terminal equipment, the ecodesign of energy-related products, and on the  
restrictions of use of certain hazardous substances in electrical and electronic equipment.  
Compliance is indicated by the CE marking.  
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY, 40550 USA.  
The authorized representative is: Lexmark International Technology Hungária Kft., 8 Lechner Ödön fasor, Millennium  
Tower III, 1095 Budapest HUNGARY. A declaration of conformity to the requirements of the Directives is available upon  
request from the Authorized Representative.  
This product satisfies the Class B limits of EN 55022 and safety requirements of EN 609501.  
Products equipped with 2.4GHz Wireless LAN option are in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council  
directives 2004/108/EC, 2006/95/EC, 1999/5/EC, 2009/125/EC, and 2011/65/EU on the approximation and  
harmonization of the laws of the Member States relating to electromagnetic compatibility, safety of electrical  
equipment designed for use within certain voltage limits, radio equipment and telecommunications terminal  
equipment, the ecodesign of energy-related products, and on the restrictions of use of certain hazardous substances  
in electrical and electronic equipment.  
Compliance is indicated by the CE marking.  
Operation is allowed in all EU and EFTA countries, but is restricted to indoor use only.  
The manufacturer of this product is: Lexmark International, Inc., 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, KY, 40550 USA.  
The authorized representative is: Lexmark International Technology Hungária Kft., 8 Lechner Ödön fasor, Millennium  
Tower III, 1095 Budapest HUNGARY. A declaration of conformity to the requirements of the Directives is available upon  
request from the Authorized Representative.  
This product may be used in the countries indicated in the table below.  
AT  
EL  
LI  
BE  
ES  
LT  
SE  
BG  
FI  
CH  
FR  
LV  
SK  
CY  
CZ  
DE  
IE  
DK  
IS  
EE  
IT  
HR  
MT  
TR  
HU  
NL  
UK  
LU  
SI  
NO  
PL  
PT  
RO  
Česky  
Společnost Lexmark International, Inc. tímto prohlašuje, že výrobek tento výrobek je ve shodě se základními  
požadavky a dalšími příslušnými ustanoveními směrnice 1999/5/ES.  
Dansk  
LexmarkInternational,Inc. erklærerherved, atdetteproduktoverholderdevæsentligekravogøvrige relevante  
krav i direktiv 1999/5/EF.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notices  
Deutsch  
249  
Hiermit erklärt Lexmark International, Inc., dass sich das Gerät dieses Gerät in Übereinstimmung mit den  
grundlegenden Anforderungen und den übrigen einschlägigen Bestimmungen der Richtlinie 1999/5/EG  
befindet.  
Ελληνική ΜΕ ΤΗΝ ΠΑΡΟΥΣΑ Η LEXMARK INTERNATIONAL, INC. ΔΗΛΩΝΕΙ ΟΤΙ ΑΥΤΟ ΤΟ ΠΡΟΪΟΝ  
ΣΥΜΜΟΡΦΩΝΕΤΑΙ ΠΡΟΣ ΤΙΣ ΟΥΣΙΩΔΕΙΣ ΑΠΑΙΤΗΣΕΙΣ ΚΑΙ ΤΙΣ ΛΟΙΠΕΣ ΣΧΕΤΙΚΕΣ ΔΙΑΤΑΞΕΙΣ  
ΤΗΣ ΟΔΗΓΙΑΣ 1999/5/ΕΚ.  
English  
Español  
Eesti  
Hereby, Lexmark International, Inc., declares that this type of equipment is in compliance with the  
essential requirements and other relevant provisions of Directive 1999/5/EC.  
Por medio de la presente, Lexmark International, Inc. declara que este producto cumple con los requisitos  
esenciales y cualesquiera otras disposiciones aplicables o exigibles de la Directiva 1999/5/CE.  
Käesolevaga kinnitab Lexmark International, Inc., et seade see toode vastab direktiivi 1999/5/EÜ  
põhinõuetele ja nimetatud direktiivist tulenevatele muudele asjakohastele sätetele.  
Suomi  
Lexmark International, Inc. vakuuttaa täten, että tämä tuote on direktiivin 1999/5/EY oleellisten vaatimusten  
ja muiden sitä koskevien direktiivin ehtojen mukainen.  
Français  
Magyar  
Íslenska  
Italiano  
Latviski  
Lietuvių  
Malti  
Par la présente, Lexmark International, Inc. déclare que l'appareil ce produit est conforme aux exigences  
fondamentales et autres dispositions pertinentes de la directive 1999/5/CE.  
Alulírott, Lexmark International, Inc. nyilatkozom, hogy a termék megfelel a vonatkozó alapvetõ  
követelményeknek és az 1999/5/EC irányelv egyéb elõírásainak.  
Hér með lýsir Lexmark International, Inc. yfir því að þessi vara er í samræmi við grunnkröfur og aðrar  
kröfur, sem gerðar eru í tilskipun 1999/5/EC.  
Con la presente Lexmark International, Inc. dichiara che questo questo prodotto è conforme ai requisiti  
essenziali ed alle altre disposizioni pertinenti stabilite dalla direttiva 1999/5/CE.  
Ar šo Lexmark International, Inc. deklarē, ka šis izstrādājums atbilst Direktīvas 1999/5/EK būtiskajām  
prasībām un citiem ar to saistītajiem noteikumiem.  
Šiuo Lexmark International, Inc. deklaruoja, kad šis produktas atitinka esminius reikalavimus ir kitas  
1999/5/EB direktyvos nuostatas.  
Bil-preżenti, Lexmark International, Inc., jiddikjara li dan il-prodott huwa konformi mal-ħtiġijiet  
essenzjali u ma dispożizzjonijiet oħrajn relevanti li jinsabu fid-Direttiva 1999/5/KE.  
Nederlands Hierbijverklaart Lexmark International, Inc. dat hettoestel ditproductinovereenstemmingismetdeessentiële  
eisen en de andere relevante bepalingen van richtlijn 1999/5/EG.  
Norsk  
Lexmark International, Inc. erklærer herved at dette produktet er i samsvar med de grunnleggende krav og  
øvrige relevante krav i direktiv 1999/5/EF.  
Polski  
Niniejszym Lexmark International, Inc. oświadcza, że niniejszy produkt jest zgodny z zasadniczymi  
wymogami oraz pozostałymi stosownymi postanowieniami Dyrektywy 1999/5/EC.  
Português A Lexmark International Inc. declara que este este produto está conforme com os requisitos essenciais e outras  
disposições da Diretiva 1999/5/CE.  
Slovensky Lexmark International, Inc. týmto vyhlasuje, že tento produkt spĺňa základné požiadavky a všetky  
príslušné ustanovenia smernice 1999/5/ES.  
Slovensko Lexmark International, Inc. izjavlja, da je ta izdelek v skladu z bistvenimi zahtevami in ostalimi  
relevantnimi določili direktive 1999/5/ES.  
Svenska  
Härmed intygar Lexmark International, Inc. att denna produkt står i överensstämmelse med de väsentliga  
egenskapskrav och övriga relevanta bestämmelser som framgår av direktiv 1999/5/EG.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notices  
250  
Patent acknowledgment  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for Elliptic Curve Cryptography (ECC) Cipher Suites for Transport  
Layer Security (TLS) implemented in the product or service.  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for TLS Elliptic Curve Cipher Suites with SHA-256/382 and AES Galois  
Counter Mode (GCM) implemented in the product or service.  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights(IPR) Disclosure ofCerticom Corp. atthe IETF for TLS Suite B Profile for Transport Layer Security (TLS) implemented  
in the product or service.  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for Addition of the Camellia Cipher Suites to Transport Layer Security  
(TLS) implemented in the product or service.  
The use of certain patents in this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the  
Intellectual Property Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for AES-CCM ECC Cipher Suites for TLS  
implemented in the product or service.  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for IKE and IKEv2 Authentication Using the Eliptic Curve Digital  
Signature Algorithm (ECDSA) implemented in the product or service.  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for Suite B Cryptographic Suites for IPSec implemented in the  
product or service.  
The use of this product or service is subject to the reasonable, non-discriminatory terms in the Intellectual Property  
Rights (IPR) Disclosure of Certicom Corp. at the IETF for Algorithms for Internet Key Exchange version 1 (IKEv1)  
implemented in the product or service.  
STATEMENT OF LIMITED WARRANTY FOR LEXMARK LASER PRINTERS,  
LEXMARK LED PRINTERS, AND LEXMARK MULTIFUNCTION LASER PRINTERS  
Lexmark International, Inc., Lexington, KY  
This limited warranty applies to the United States and Canada. For customers outside the U.S., refer to the country-  
specific warranty information that came with your product.  
This limited warranty applies to this product only if it was originally purchased for your use, and not for resale, from  
Lexmark or a Lexmark Remarketer, referred to in this statement as “Remarketer.”  
Limited warranty  
Lexmark warrants that this product:  
—Is manufactured from new parts, or new and serviceable used parts, which perform like new parts  
—Is, during normal use, free from defects in material and workmanship  
If this product does not function as warranted during the warranty period, contact a Remarketer or Lexmark for repair  
or replacement (at Lexmark's option).  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notices  
251  
If this product is a feature or option, this statement applies only when that feature or option is used with the product  
for which it was intended. To obtain warranty service, you may be required to present the feature or option with the  
product.  
If you transfer this product to another user, warranty service under the terms of this statement is available to that user  
for the remainder of the warranty period. You should transfer proof of original purchase and this statement to that  
user.  
Limited warranty service  
The warranty period starts on the date of original purchase as shown on the purchase receipt and ends 12 months later  
provided that the warranty period for any supplies and for any maintenance items included with the printer shall end  
earlier if it, or its original contents, are substantially used up, depleted, or consumed. Fuser Units, Transfer/Transport  
Units, Paper Feed items, if any, and any other items for which a Maintenance Kit is available are substantially consumed  
when the printer displays a “Life Warning” or “Scheduled Maintenance” message for such item.  
To obtain warranty service you may be required to present proof of original purchase. You may be required to deliver  
your product to the Remarketer or Lexmark, or ship it prepaid and suitably packaged to a Lexmark designated location.  
You are responsible for loss of, or damage to, a product in transit to the Remarketer or the Lexmark designated location.  
When warranty service involves the exchange of a product or part, the item replaced becomes the property of the  
Remarketer or Lexmark. The replacement may be a new or repaired item.  
The replacement item assumes the remaining warranty period of the original product.  
Replacement is not available to you if the product you present for exchange is defaced, altered, in need of a repair not  
included in warranty service, damaged beyond repair, or if the product is not free of all legal obligations, restrictions,  
liens, and encumbrances.  
As part of your warranty service and/or replacement, Lexmark may update the firmware in your printer to the latest  
version. Firmware updates may modify printer settings and cause counterfeit and/or unauthorized products, supplies,  
parts, materials (such as toners and inks), software, or interfaces to stop working. Authorized use of genuine Lexmark  
products will not be impacted.  
Before youpresentthisproduct for warranty service, removeallprint cartridges, programs, data, andremovable storage  
media (unless directed otherwise by Lexmark).  
For further explanation of your warranty alternatives and the nearest Lexmark authorized servicer in your area contact  
Lexmark on the World Wide Web.  
Remote technical support is provided for this product throughout its warranty period. For products no longer covered  
by a Lexmark warranty, technical support may not be available or only be available for a fee.  
Extent of limited warranty  
Lexmark does not warrant uninterrupted or error-free operation of any product or the durability or longevity of prints  
produced by any product.  
Warranty service does not include repair of failures caused by:  
—Modification or unauthorized attachments  
—Accidents, misuse, abuse or use inconsistent with Lexmark user’s guides, manuals, instructions or guidance  
—Unsuitable physical or operating environment  
—Maintenance by anyone other than Lexmark or a Lexmark authorized servicer  
—Operation of a product beyond the limit of its duty cycle  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notices  
252  
—Use of printing media outside of Lexmark specifications  
—Refurbishment, repair, refilling or remanufacture by a third party of products, supplies or parts  
—Products, supplies, parts, materials (such as toners and inks), software, or interfaces not furnished by Lexmark  
TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, NEITHER LEXMARK NOR ITS THIRD PARTY SUPPLIERS OR  
REMARKETERS MAKE ANY OTHER WARRANTY OR CONDITION OF ANY KIND, WHETHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WITH  
RESPECT TO THIS PRODUCT, AND SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIM THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF  
MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, AND SATISFACTORY QUALITY. ANY WARRANTIES THAT  
MAY NOT BE DISCLAIMED UNDER APPLICABLE LAW ARE LIMITED IN DURATION TO THE WARRANTY PERIOD. NO  
WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WILL APPLY AFTER THIS PERIOD. ALL INFORMATION, SPECIFICATIONS, PRICES,  
AND SERVICES ARE SUBJECT TO CHANGE AT ANY TIME WITHOUT NOTICE.  
Limitation of liability  
Your sole remedy under this limited warranty is set forth in this document. For any claim concerning performance or  
nonperformance of Lexmark or a Remarketer for this product under this limited warranty, you may recover actual  
damages up to the limit set forth in the following paragraph.  
Lexmark's liability for actual damages from any cause whatsoever will be limited to the amount you paid for the product  
that caused the damages. This limitation of liability will not apply to claims by you for bodily injury or damage to real  
property or tangible personal property for which Lexmark is legally liable. IN NO EVENT WILL LEXMARK BE LIABLE FOR  
ANY LOST PROFITS, LOST SAVINGS, INCIDENTAL DAMAGE, OR OTHER ECONOMIC OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES.  
This is true even if you advise Lexmark or a Remarketer of the possibility of such damages. Lexmark is not liable for any  
claim by you based on a third party claim.  
This limitation of remedies also applies to claims against any Suppliers and Remarketers of Lexmark. Lexmark's and its  
Suppliers' and Remarketers' limitations of remedies are not cumulative. Such Suppliers and Remarketers are intended  
beneficiaries of this limitation.  
Additional rights  
Some states do not allow limitations on how long an implied warranty lasts, or do not allow the exclusion or limitation  
of incidental or consequential damages, so the limitations or exclusions contained above may not apply to you.  
This limited warranty gives you specific legal rights. You may also have other rights that vary from state to state.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
253  
Index  
available internal options 15  
avoiding jams 49  
avoiding paper jams 164  
cleaning  
Numerics  
250sheet tray  
installing 19  
550sheet tray  
installing 19  
exterior of the printer 151  
scanner glass 152  
cleaning the printer 151  
Close flatbed cover and load  
originals if restarting job  
[2yy.xx] 177  
Close front door 177  
collate  
copy options 64  
B
back button  
printer control panel 12  
binding  
fax options 88  
Symbols  
[x]page jam, clear manual feeder.  
[25y.xx] 173  
blocking junk faxes 85  
[x]page jam, clear standard bin.  
[20y.xx] 170  
[x]page jam, open automatic  
feeder top cover. [28y.xx] 175  
[x]page jam, open front door.  
[20y.xx] 166  
collating copies 61  
Complex page, some data may not  
have printed [39] 177  
compressed images appear on  
prints 202  
confidential data  
information on securing 150  
confidential jobs  
modifying print settings 52  
confidential print jobs 51  
printing from a Macintosh  
computer 52  
printing from Windows 52  
configuration information  
wireless network 24  
configurations  
printer 10  
Configure MP menu 96  
configuring  
supply notifications, imaging  
supply notifications, maintenance  
supply notifications, toner  
cartridge 162  
configuring email settings 66  
configuring supply notifications  
from the Embedded Web  
connecting to a wireless network  
using PBC, Push Button  
Configuration method 26  
using PIN, Personal Identification  
Number method 26  
using the Embedded Web  
C
cables  
Ethernet 22  
canceling  
fax job 86  
canceling a copy job from the  
printer control panel 63  
canceling a print job  
from a computer 53  
from the printer control panel 53  
canceling an e-mail 67  
cannot open Embedded Web  
[x]page jam, open rear door.  
[20y.xx] 169  
[x]page jam, open tray [x].  
[24y.xx] 172  
[x]page jam, remove tray 1 to clear  
duplex. [23y.xx] 171  
A
accessing the remote control panel  
Embedded Web Server 161  
Active NIC menu 103  
adapter plug 77  
card stock  
loading, multipurpose feeder 34  
adding hardware options  
print driver 23  
address book button  
printer control panel 12  
ADF  
copying using 55  
adjusting printer display  
brightness 146  
adjusting Sleep mode 145  
adjusting toner darkness 50  
administrator settings  
Embedded Web Server 161  
advanced duplex  
copy options 65  
answering machine  
setting up 70  
Cartridge low [88.xy] 176  
Cartridge nearly low [88.xy] 176  
Cartridge very low, [x] estimated  
pages remain [88.xy] 176  
Change [paper source] to [custom  
string] load [paper orientation] 176  
Change [paper source] to [custom  
type name] load [orientation] 176  
Change [paper source] to [paper  
size] load [orientation] 177  
Change [paper source] to [paper  
type] [paper size] load  
[orientation] 177  
checking an unresponsive  
printer 190  
checking status of parts and  
supplies 153  
checking the status of parts and  
supplies 153  
AppleTalk menu 108  
arrow buttons  
printer control panel 12  
attaching cables 22  
using wireless setup wizard 25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Index  
254  
conservation settings  
brightness, adjusting 146  
conserving supplies 143  
EcoMode 144  
canceling a copy job from the  
printer control panel 63  
collating copies 61  
enlarging 59  
making a copy lighter or darker 59  
multiple pages on one sheet 62  
on letterhead 57  
on transparencies 56  
photos 56  
placing separator sheets between  
copies 61  
display, printer control panel  
adjusting brightness 146  
distinctive ring service  
connecting to 81  
documents, printing  
from Macintosh 50  
from Windows 50  
Hibernate mode 146  
Quiet mode 144  
Schedule Power Modes 146  
Sleep mode 145  
conserving supplies 143  
contacting customer support 233  
control panel, printer  
indicator light 13  
Sleep button light 13  
controller board  
accessing 15  
DSL filter 74  
E
EcoMode setting 144  
Embedded Web Server  
accessing the remote control  
quick copy 55  
reducing 59  
selecting a tray 58  
to a different size 58  
using the ADF 55  
using the scanner glass 56  
creating a fax destination shortcut  
using the Embedded Web  
creating an FTP shortcut  
using the Embedded Web  
custom paper type  
assigning 39  
custom paper type name  
creating 39  
Custom Scan Sizes menu 101  
Custom Type [x]  
assigning a paper type 39  
Custom Type [x] name  
creating 39  
Custom Types menu 100  
customer support  
adjusting brightness 146  
administrator settings 161  
checking the status of parts 153  
checking the status of  
supplies 153  
creating a fax destination  
shortcut 84  
creating an FTP shortcut 89  
creating email shortcuts 67  
initial fax setup 69  
copies  
copy options 63  
copy from  
copy options 63  
copy job  
canceling 63  
copy options  
advanced duplex 65  
copies 63  
copy from 63  
modifying confidential print  
settings 52  
copy to 64  
darkness 64  
overlay 65  
paper saver 65  
networking settings 161  
problem accessing 232  
setting up email alerts 161  
Embedded Web Server  
Administrator's Guide  
where to find 150, 161  
emission  
enlarging a copy 59  
envelopes  
scale 64  
separator sheets 65  
sides (duplex) 64  
copy quality  
adjusting 60  
copy screen  
contacting 233  
content source 65  
content type 64, 88  
Copy Settings menu 115  
copy to  
copy options 64  
copy troubleshooting  
copier does not respond 219  
partial document or photo  
poor copy quality 220  
poor scanned image quality 231  
scanner unit does not  
D
loading, multipurpose feeder 34  
tips on using 47  
darkness  
copy options 64  
fax options 88  
environmental settings  
conserving supplies 143  
EcoMode 144  
date and time, fax  
setting 82  
daylight savings time, faxing 82  
Default Source menu 93  
Defective flash detected [51] 178  
Digital Subscriber Line (DSL)  
fax setup 74  
digital telephone service  
fax setup 76  
display troubleshooting  
printer display is blank 192  
Hibernate mode 146  
printer display brightness,  
adjusting 146  
Quiet mode 144  
Schedule Power Modes 146  
Sleep mode 145  
erasing nonvolatile memory 149  
erasing volatile memory 149  
Error reading USB drive. Remove  
USB. 178  
copying  
adding an overlay message 62  
adjusting quality 60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
255  
Error reading USB hub. Remove  
Ethernet network  
preparing to set up for Ethernet  
printing 24  
orientation 88  
resolution 87  
Fax partition inoperative. Contact  
system administrator. 178  
fax ports 22  
FCC notices 237, 242, 246  
finding more information about the  
printer 8  
Finishing menu 133  
font sample list  
Ethernet port 22  
Ethernet setup  
preparing for an 24  
EXT ports 22  
exterior of the printer  
cleaning 151  
fax screen  
content source 88  
printing 53  
forwarding faxes 87  
FTP address, scanning to  
using a shortcut 90  
FTP Settings menu 129  
Fax server 'To Format' not set up.  
Contact system administrator. 178  
fax setup  
countryor regionspecific 77  
digital telephone service 76  
DSL connection 74  
standard telephone line  
connection 70  
VoIP 75  
Fax Station Name not set up.  
Contact system administrator. 178  
Fax Station Number not set up.  
Contact system administrator. 179  
fax troubleshooting  
caller ID is not shown 223  
can receive but not send  
can send but not receive  
cannot send or receive a fax 224  
received fax has poor print  
quality 228  
email  
G
canceling 67  
General Settings menu 111  
green settings  
email alerts  
low supply levels 161  
paper jam 161  
EcoMode 144  
Hibernate mode 146  
Quiet mode 144  
Schedule Power Modes 146  
setting up 161  
email function  
setting up 66  
Email Settings menu 126  
email shortcuts, creating  
using the Embedded Web  
H
hardware options, adding  
print driver 23  
held jobs 51  
printing from a Macintosh  
computer 52  
printing from Windows 52  
Help menu 141  
Hibernate mode  
holding faxes 86  
home button  
email, sending  
using a shortcut number 67  
emailing  
configuring email settings 66  
creating shortcuts using the  
Embedded Web Server 67  
setting up email function 66  
using a shortcut number 67  
fax, sending  
using shortcuts 83  
using the printer control panel 82  
faxing  
printer control panel 12  
HTML menu 140  
F
blocking junk faxes 85  
canceling a fax job 86  
changing resolution 84  
configuring the printer to observe  
daylight saving time 82  
creating shortcuts using the  
Embedded Web Server 84  
fax setup 69  
forwarding faxes 87  
holding faxes 86  
making a fax lighter or darker 85  
sending a fax at a scheduled  
time 83  
factory defaults, restoring 163  
fax  
I
options 87, 88  
fax button  
printer control panel 12  
fax connection  
connecting to a distinctive ring  
service 81  
Image menu 141  
imaging unit  
ordering 154  
replacing 157  
Imaging unit low [84.xy] 179  
Imaging unit nearly low [84.xy] 179  
Imaging unit very low, [x] estimated  
pages remain [84.xy] 179  
Incorrect paper size, open [paper  
source] [34] 179  
indicator light  
printer control panel 12  
initial fax setup 69  
fax function  
setting up 222  
fax function is not set up 222  
fax log  
viewing 85  
setting the date and time 82  
setting the fax number or station  
number 81  
setting the outgoing fax name or  
station name 81  
Fax memory full 178  
Fax Mode (Analog Fax Setup)  
fax options  
binding 88  
using the Embedded Web  
installing an optional card 17  
viewing a fax log 85  
darkness 88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
256  
installing options  
order of installation 18  
installing printer 23  
Load [paper source] with [paper  
size] [paper orientation] 182  
Load [paper source] with [paper  
type] [paper size] [paper  
orientation] 182  
Load manual feeder with [custom  
string] [paper orientation] 180  
Load manual feeder with [custom  
type name] [paper orientation] 181  
Load manual feeder with [paper  
size] [paper orientation] 181  
Load manual feeder with [paper  
type] [paper size] [paper  
orientation] 181  
HTML 140  
Image 141  
IPv6 106  
list of 92  
Network [x] 103  
Network Card 104  
Network Reports 104  
Paper Loading 99  
Paper Size/Type 93  
Paper Texture 96  
Paper Weight 98  
PCL Emul 137  
installing the 250sheet tray 19  
installing the 550sheet tray 19  
Insufficient memory for Flash  
Memory Defragment operation  
Insufficient memory to collate job  
Insufficient memory to support  
Resource Save feature [35] 180  
Insufficient memory, some Held  
Jobs were deleted [37] 180  
Insufficient memory, some held  
jobs will not be restored [37] 180  
IPv6 menu 106  
PDF 137  
Quality 135  
Reports 102  
loading  
multipurpose feeder 34  
trays 29  
loading the optional tray 29  
loading the standard tray 29  
Security Audit Log 109  
Set Date and Time 110  
Setup 133  
SMTP Setup menu 108  
Standard Network 103  
Substitute Size 96  
TCP/IP 105  
Universal Setup 101  
Wireless 107  
menus list 92  
mobile device  
printing from 51  
moving the printer 9, 160  
multiple pages on one sheet 62  
multipurpose feeder  
loading 34  
J
jams  
M
accessing 165  
avoiding 164  
understanding messages 165  
jams, clearing  
in automatic document feeder top  
cover 175  
in duplex area 171  
in front door 166  
in manual feeder 173  
in rear door 169  
in standard bin 170  
in tray [x] 172  
maintenance kit  
ordering 154  
Maintenance kit low [80.xy] 182  
Maintenance kit nearly low  
[80.xy] 183  
Maintenance kit very low, [x]  
estimated pages remain  
[80.xy] 183  
memory  
types installed on printer 149  
Memory full [38] 183  
Memory full, cannot print  
Memory full, cannot send  
menu settings page  
printing 27  
menus  
K
N
keypad  
Network [x] menu 103  
Network [x] software error  
printer control panel 12  
L
Network Card menu 104  
Network Reports menu 104  
network settings  
Embedded Web Server 161  
network setup page  
printing 28  
Networking Guide  
where to find 161  
No analog phone line connected to  
modem, fax is disabled. 184  
noise emission levels 237  
noise, printer  
labels, paper  
Active NIC 103  
tips on using 48  
letterhead  
copying on 57  
loading, multipurpose feeder 34  
tips on using 47  
line filter 74  
LINE ports 22  
linking trays 38  
Load [paper source] with [custom  
string] [paper orientation] 181  
Load [paper source] with [custom  
type name] [paper orientation] 182  
Configure MP 96  
Copy Settings 115  
Custom Scan Sizes 101  
Custom Types 100  
Default Source 93  
Email Settings 126  
Fax Mode (Analog Fax Setup) 119  
Finishing 133  
FTP Settings 129  
General Settings 111  
reducing 144  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
257  
NonLexmark [supply type], see  
User’s Guide [33.xy] 184  
nonvolatile memory 149  
erasing 149  
Not enough free space in flash  
memory for resources [52] 184  
paper jams  
avoiding 164  
paper jams, clearing  
in automatic document feeder top  
cover 175  
in duplex area 171  
in front door 166  
in manual feeder 173  
in rear door 169  
in standard bin 170  
in tray [x] 172  
print job  
canceling from the printer control  
canceling, from computer 53  
print quality  
cleaning the scanner glass 152  
print quality troubleshooting  
blank pages 210  
characters have jagged edges 201  
clipped pages or images 201  
compressed images appear on  
prints 202  
number of remaining pages  
estimate 153  
paper labels  
loading, multipurpose feeder 34  
Paper Loading menu 99  
paper messages  
[x]page jam, remove tray 1 to  
clear duplex. [23y.xx] 171  
paper saver  
copy options 65  
Paper Size/Type menu 93  
paper sizes  
supported 44  
Paper Texture menu 96  
paper types  
supported by printer 46  
where to load 46  
Paper Weight menu 98  
paper weights  
supported by printer 46  
parts  
checking status 153  
checking, using the Embedded  
using genuine Lexmark 154  
parts and supplies, status of  
checking, on printer control  
PCL Emul menu 137  
PDF menu 137  
Personal Identification Number  
method  
using 26  
phone splitter 75  
photos  
copying 56  
gray background on prints 203  
horizontal voids appear on  
prints 204  
print irregularities 206  
print is too dark 208  
print is too light 209  
printer is printing solid black  
pages 211  
repeating print defects appear on  
prints 212  
shadow images appear on  
prints 213  
skewed print 213  
streaked horizontal lines appear  
on prints 214  
O
optional card  
installing 17  
optional tray  
loading 29  
options  
250sheet tray, installing 19  
550sheet tray, installing 19  
memory cards 15  
ordering  
imaging unit 154  
maintenance kit 154  
ordering supplies  
toner cartridge 154  
orientation  
fax options 88  
overlay  
streaked vertical lines 215  
toner fog or background  
shading 216  
toner rubs off 217  
copy options 65  
overlay message, adding  
copying 62  
toner specks appear on prints 217  
transparency print quality is  
poor 217  
uneven print density 218  
white streaks 218  
print troubleshooting  
incorrect characters print 195  
incorrect margins on prints 205  
jammed pages are not  
reprinted 194  
job prints from wrong tray 195  
job prints on wrong paper 195  
jobs do not print 197  
Large jobs do not collate 196  
multiplelanguage PDF files do not  
print 197  
P
paper  
characteristics 41  
letterhead 42  
loading, multipurpose feeder 34  
preprinted forms 42  
recycled 42  
selecting 42  
setting size 29  
setting type 29  
storing 49  
placing separator sheets between  
copies 61  
preparing to set up the printer on  
an Ethernet network 24  
print driver  
hardware options, adding 23  
print irregularities 206  
unacceptable 42  
Universal size setting 29  
using recycled 143  
paper feed troubleshooting  
message remains after jam is  
cleared 195  
paper curl 206  
paper frequently jams 194  
print job takes longer than  
expected 198  
tray linking does not work 200  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
258  
unexpected page breaks  
occur 200  
printer 23  
minimum clearances 9  
moving 9, 160  
selecting a location 9  
shipping 160  
printer configurations 10  
basic model 10  
configured model 10  
printer control panel  
adjusting brightness 146  
factory defaults, restoring 163  
indicator light 13  
Close front door 177  
Complex page, some data may not  
have printed [39] 177  
Defective flash detected [51] 178  
Error reading USB drive. Remove  
USB. 178  
Error reading USB hub. Remove  
Load manual feeder with [custom  
type name] [paper  
orientation] 181  
Load manual feeder with [paper  
size] [paper orientation] 181  
Load manual feeder with [paper  
type] [paper size] [paper  
orientation] 181  
Maintenance kit low [80.xy] 182  
Maintenance kit nearly low  
[80.xy] 183  
Fax memory full 178  
Fax partition inoperative. Contact  
system administrator. 178  
Fax server 'To Format' not set up.  
Contact system  
Maintenance kit very low, [x]  
estimated pages remain  
[80.xy] 183  
administrator. 178  
Sleep button light 13  
using 12  
Printer had to restart. Last job may  
be incomplete. 184  
Fax Station Name not set up.  
Contact system  
administrator. 178  
Fax Station Number not set up.  
Contact system  
Memory full [38] 183  
Memory full, cannot print  
Memory full, cannot send  
printer information  
where to find 8  
printer is printing blank pages 210  
printer messages  
administrator. 179  
Network [x] software error  
Imaging unit low [84.xy] 179  
Imaging unit nearly low  
[84.xy] 179  
Imaging unit very low, [x]  
estimated pages remain  
[84.xy] 179  
Incorrect paper size, open [paper  
source] [34] 179  
Insufficient memory for Flash  
Memory Defragment operation  
No analog phone line connected  
to modem, fax is disabled. 184  
NonLexmark [supply type], see  
User’s Guide [33.xy] 184  
Not enough free space in flash  
memory for resources [52] 184  
Printer had to restart. Last job  
may be incomplete. 184  
Reinstall missing or unresponsive  
cartridge [31.xy] 185  
Reinstall missing or unresponsive  
imaging unit [31.xy] 185  
Remove paper from standard  
output bin 185  
Replace all originals if restarting  
job. 185  
Replace cartridge, 0 estimated  
pages remain [88.xy] 185  
Replace cartridge, printer region  
mismatch [42.xy] 186  
Replace defective imaging unit  
[31.xy] 186  
Replace imaging unit, 0 estimated  
pages remain [84.xy] 186  
Replace jammed originals if  
restarting job. 187  
Replace maintenance kit, 0  
estimated pages remain  
[80.xy] 187  
Replace unsupported cartridge  
[32.xy] 187  
[x]page jam, clear manual feeder.  
[25y.xx] 173  
[x]page jam, clear standard bin.  
[20y.xx] 170  
[x]page jam, open automatic  
feeder top cover. [28y.xx] 175  
[x]page jam, open front door.  
[20y.xx] 166  
[x]page jam, open rear door.  
[20y.xx] 169  
Insufficient memory to collate job  
[x]page jam, open tray [x].  
[24y.xx] 172  
Insufficient memory to support  
Resource Save feature [35] 180  
Insufficient memory, some Held  
Jobs were deleted [37] 180  
Insufficient memory, some held  
jobs will not be restored  
Load [paper source] with [custom  
string] [paper orientation] 181  
Load [paper source] with [custom  
type name] [paper  
Cartridge low [88.xy] 176  
Cartridge nearly low [88.xy] 176  
Cartridge very low, [x] estimated  
pages remain [88.xy] 176  
Change [paper source] to [custom  
string] load [paper  
orientation] 176  
Change [paper source] to [custom  
type name] load  
[orientation] 176  
Change [paper source] to [paper  
size] load [orientation] 177  
Change [paper source] to [paper  
type] [paper size] load  
[orientation] 177  
Close flatbed cover and load  
originals if restarting job  
[2yy.xx] 177  
orientation] 182  
Load [paper source] with [paper  
size] [paper orientation] 182  
Load [paper source] with [paper  
type] [paper size] [paper  
orientation] 182  
Load manual feeder with [custom  
string] [paper orientation] 180  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
259  
Replace unsupported imaging unit  
[32.xy] 187  
Scanner automatic feeder cover  
open 187  
publications  
where to find 8  
Push Button Configuration method  
using 26  
replacing  
imaging unit 157  
toner cartridge 156  
reports  
Scanner disabled by admin  
Scanner disabled. Contact system  
administrator if problem persists.  
viewing 162  
Reports menu 102  
reserve print jobs 51  
printing from a Macintosh  
computer 52  
Q
Quality menu 135  
Quiet mode 144  
Scanner jam, remove all originals  
from the scanner [2yy.xx] 188  
Scanner jam, remove jammed  
originals from the scanner  
[2yy.xx] 188  
Serial option [x] error [54] 188  
SMTP server not set up. Contact  
system administrator. 188, 190  
Standard network software error  
Standard USB port disabled  
Supply needed to complete  
job 189  
Too many flash options installed  
Too many trays attached [58] 189  
Unformatted flash detected  
Unsupported USB hub, please  
printer options troubleshooting  
internal option is not  
detected 192  
printing from Windows 52  
reset button  
printer control panel 12  
resolution  
fax options 87  
resolution, fax  
R
recycled paper  
recycling  
Lexmark packaging 147  
Lexmark products 147  
toner cartridges 147  
reducing a copy 59  
changing 84  
RJ11 adapter 77  
reducing noise 144  
S
Reinstall missing or unresponsive  
cartridge [31.xy] 185  
Reinstall missing or unresponsive  
imaging unit [31.xy] 185  
remote control panel  
using Embedded Web Server 161  
Remove paper from standard  
output bin 185  
repeat print jobs 51  
printing from a Macintosh  
computer 52  
printing from Windows 52  
repeating print defects appear on  
prints 212  
Replace all originals if restarting  
job. 185  
Replace cartridge, 0 estimated  
pages remain [88.xy] 185  
Replace cartridge, printer region  
mismatch [42.xy] 186  
Replace defective imaging unit  
[31.xy] 186  
Replace imaging unit, 0 estimated  
pages remain [84.xy] 186  
Replace jammed originals if  
restarting job. 187  
Replace maintenance kit, 0  
estimated pages remain  
[80.xy] 187  
Replace unsupported cartridge  
[32.xy] 187  
safety information 6, 7  
scale  
copy options 64  
scan troubleshooting  
partial document or photo  
scan job was not successful 230  
scanner unit does not  
scanning takes too long or freezes  
the computer 230  
scanner  
Automatic document feeder  
(ADF) 12  
functions 11  
scanner glass 12  
Scanner automatic feeder cover  
open 187  
Scanner disabled by admin  
Scanner disabled. Contact system  
administrator if problem persists.  
scanner glass  
cleaning 152  
tray problems 193  
printer problems, solving basic 190  
printer security  
information on 150  
printing  
font sample list 53  
from a mobile device 51  
from Macintosh 50  
from Windows 50  
menu settings page 27  
network setup page 28  
printing a document 50  
printing a network setup page 28  
printing confidential and other held  
jobs  
from a Macintosh computer 52  
from Windows 52  
printing from a mobile device 51  
printing slows down 199  
copying using 56  
Scanner jam, remove all originals  
from the scanner [2yy.xx] 188  
Scanner jam, remove jammed  
originals from the scanner  
[2yy.xx] 188  
scanning  
quick copy 55  
Replace unsupported imaging unit  
[32.xy] 187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
260  
to a computer 91  
shortcuts, creating  
email 67  
supply notifications  
configuring 162  
supported paper sizes 44  
scanning to a computer 91  
scanning to an FTP address  
creating shortcuts using the  
computer 89  
using a shortcut 90  
Schedule Power Modes  
security  
modifying confidential print  
settings 52  
Security Audit Log menu 109  
security slot 22  
security Web page  
where to find 150  
select button  
printer control panel 12  
selecting a location for the  
printer 9  
selecting paper 42  
sending a fax using the  
computer 83  
sending fax  
using shortcuts 83  
using the printer control panel 82  
sending fax at a scheduled time 83  
separator pad  
ordering 155  
separator sheets  
copy options 65  
Serial option [x] error [54] 188  
Set Date and Time menu 110  
setting  
paper size 29  
paper type 29  
TCP/IP address 105  
setting the fax number or station  
number 81  
setting the outgoing fax name or  
station name 81  
setting the Universal paper size 29  
setting up email alerts 161  
setting up fax  
countryor regionspecific 77  
digital telephone service 76  
DSL connection 74  
standard telephone line  
connection 70  
fax destination 84  
FTP destination 89  
sides (duplex)  
T
copy options 64  
sleep button  
printer control panel 12  
Sleep mode  
adjusting 145  
SMTP server not set up. Contact  
system administrator. 188, 190  
SMTP Setup menu 108  
Standard Network menu 103  
Standard network software error  
standard tray  
loading 29  
Standard USB port disabled  
start button  
printer control panel 12  
statement of volatility 149  
status of parts and supplies  
checking 153  
stop or cancel button  
printer control panel 12  
storing  
supplies 155  
storing print jobs 51  
streaked horizontal lines appear on  
prints 214  
streaked vertical lines appear on  
prints 215  
streaks appear 218  
Substitute Size menu 96  
supplies  
checking status 153  
checking, using the Embedded  
TCP/IP menu 105  
telecommunication  
the scanner does not respond 229  
tips  
card stock 48  
letterhead 47  
on using envelopes 47  
on using labels 48  
transparencies 47  
tips on using envelopes 47  
toner cartridge  
ordering 154  
replacing 156  
toner cartridges  
recycling 147  
toner darkness  
adjusting 50  
Too many flash options installed  
Too many trays attached [58] 189  
transparencies  
copying on 56  
loading, multipurpose feeder 34  
trays  
linking 38  
loading 29  
unlinking 38  
troubleshooting  
cannot open Embedded Web  
checking an unresponsive  
printer 190  
contacting customer support 233  
fax function is not set up 222  
solving basic printer  
problems 190  
the scanner does not respond 229  
troubleshooting, copy  
copier does not respond 219  
partial document or photo  
poor copy quality 220  
poor scanned image quality 231  
scanner unit does not  
conserving 143  
storing 155  
using genuine Lexmark 154  
using recycled paper 143  
supplies, ordering  
imaging unit 154  
maintenance kit 154  
separator pad 155  
toner cartridge 154  
Supply needed to complete job 189  
VoIP connection 75  
setting up fax function 222  
Setup menu 133  
shipping the printer 160  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
261  
troubleshooting, display  
printer display is blank 192  
troubleshooting, fax  
caller ID is not shown 223  
can receive but not send  
can send but not receive  
cannot send or receive a fax 224  
received fax has poor print  
quality 228  
streaked horizontal lines appear  
on prints 214  
streaked vertical lines 215  
toner fog or background  
shading 216  
viewing  
reports 162  
viewing a fax log 85  
voice mail  
setting up 70  
Voice over Internet Protocol (VoIP)  
fax setup 75  
voids appear 218  
VoIP adapter 75  
volatile memory 149  
erasing 149  
volatility  
statement of 149  
toner rubs off 217  
toner specks appear on prints 217  
transparency print quality is  
poor 217  
uneven print density 218  
white streaks on a page 218  
troubleshooting, printer options  
internal option is not  
detected 192  
troubleshooting, paper feed  
message remains after jam is  
cleared 195  
troubleshooting, print  
incorrect characters print 195  
incorrect margins on prints 205  
jammed pages are not  
reprinted 194  
job prints from wrong tray 195  
job prints on wrong paper 195  
jobs do not print 197  
Large jobs do not collate 196  
multiplelanguage PDF files do not  
print 197  
tray problems 193  
W
troubleshooting, printing  
printing slows down 199  
troubleshooting, scan  
partial document or photo  
scan job was not successful 230  
scanner unit does not  
Wireless menu 107  
wireless network  
configuration information 24  
wireless network setup  
using the Embedded Web  
wireless setup wizard  
using 25  
scanning takes too long or freezes  
the computer 230  
X
paper curl 206  
XPS menu 137  
paper frequently jams 194  
print job takes longer than  
expected 198  
tray linking does not work 200  
unexpected page breaks  
occur 200  
troubleshooting, print quality  
blank pages 210  
characters have jagged edges 201  
clipped pages or images 201  
compressed images appear on  
prints 202  
gray background on prints 203  
horizontal voids appear on  
prints 204  
print irregularities 206  
print is too dark 208  
print is too light 209  
printer is printing solid black  
pages 211  
repeating print defects appear on  
prints 212  
shadow images appear on  
prints 213  
U
uneven print density 218  
Unformatted flash detected  
Universal paper size  
setting 29  
Universal Setup menu 101  
unlinking trays 38  
Unsupported USB hub, please  
USB port 22  
using Hibernate mode 146  
using recycled paper 143  
using Schedule Power Modes 146  
using shortcuts  
sending fax 83  
Utilities menu 136  
V
verify print jobs 51  
printing from a Macintosh  
computer 52  
printing from Windows 52  
vertical voids appear 218  
skewed print 213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

KTM Motorcycle Accessories 690E User Manual
Learning Resources Games LER 1576 User Manual
Life Fitness Home Gym G3 GLPA 001 User Manual
Lucent Technologies Telephone 108522426 User Manual
Magic Chef Food Warmer MCSBABSS3S User Manual
Makita Impact Driver 6992D User Manual
Marmitek Stereo Receiver GigaVideo 580 User Manual
MB QUART Speaker NWD254 User Manual
Metra Electronics Automobile Accessories 70 2103T User Manual
MHP Gas Grill JNR User Manual